blob: ae4827a88af921d6dd56109c4cc1f16996dea0a6 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau37242fa2010-08-28 19:21:00 +02007 2010/08/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -d
421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
438 - nbproc
439 - pidfile
440 - uid
441 - ulimit-n
442 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200443 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200444 - node
445 - description
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100446
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 * Performance tuning
448 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100449 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - noepoll
451 - nokqueue
452 - nopoll
453 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200455 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200456 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200457 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100458 - tune.maxaccept
459 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200460 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100461 - tune.rcvbuf.client
462 - tune.rcvbuf.server
463 - tune.sndbuf.client
464 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Debugging
467 - debug
468 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469
470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004713.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200472------------------------------------
473
474chroot <jail dir>
475 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
476 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
477 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
478 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
479 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
480 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100481
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200482daemon
483 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
484 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
485 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
486
487gid <number>
488 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
489 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
490 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
491 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493group <group name>
494 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
495 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100496
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200497log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200498 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
499 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100500 configured with "log global".
501
502 <address> can be one of:
503
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100504 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100505 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
506 port).
507
508 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
509 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
510 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
511 writeable).
512
513 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200514
515 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
516 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
517 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
518
519 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200520 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
521 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
522 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
523 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
524 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
525 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526
527 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
528
529nbproc <number>
530 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
531 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
532 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
533 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
534 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
535
536pidfile <pidfile>
537 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
538 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
539 starting the process. See also "daemon".
540
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200541stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200542 [level <level>]
543
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200544 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
545 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100546 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200547 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
548
549 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
550 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
551 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
552 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
553 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
554
555 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
556 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
557 counters).
558
559 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
560 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100561
562 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
563 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
564 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
565 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
566 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
567 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
568 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200569
570stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
571 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
572 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100573 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200574
575stats maxconn <connections>
576 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
577 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
578
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200579uid <number>
580 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
581 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
582 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
583 one. See also "gid" and "user".
584
585ulimit-n <number>
586 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
587 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
588 option.
589
590user <user name>
591 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
592 See also "uid" and "group".
593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200594node <name>
595 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
596
597 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
598 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
599 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
600 traffic.
601
602description <text>
603 Add a text that describes the instance.
604
605 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
606 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
607 "<" and ">" characters.
608
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006103.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611-----------------------
612
613maxconn <number>
614 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
615 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
616 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
617 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
618
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100619maxpipes <number>
620 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
621 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
622 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
623 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
624 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
625 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627noepoll
628 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
629 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
630 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
631
632nokqueue
633 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
634 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
635 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
636
637nopoll
638 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
639 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100640 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
642 "nokqueue".
643
644nosepoll
645 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
646 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
647 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
648
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649nosplice
650 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
651 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
652 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100653 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100654 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
655 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
656 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
657 "option splice-response".
658
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200659spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
660 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
661 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
662 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
663 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
664 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
665
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200666tune.bufsize <number>
667 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
668 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
669 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
670 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
671 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
672 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
673 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
674 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
675
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200676tune.chksize <number>
677 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
678 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
679 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
680 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
681 checks whenever possible.
682
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100683tune.maxaccept <number>
684 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
685 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
686 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100687 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100688 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
689 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100690 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100691 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
692
693tune.maxpollevents <number>
694 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
695 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
696 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
697 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
698 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
699
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200700tune.maxrewrite <number>
701 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
702 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
703 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
704 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
705 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
706 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
707 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
708 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
709 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
710 bufsize.
711
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100712tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
713tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
714 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
715 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
716 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
717 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
718 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
719 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
720 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
721
722tune.sndbuf.client <number>
723tune.sndbuf.server <number>
724 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
725 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
726 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
727 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
728 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
729 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
730 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
731 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
732 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
733 notifying haproxy again.
734
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007363.3. Debugging
737--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738
739debug
740 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
741 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
742 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
743 system startup.
744
745quiet
746 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
747 line argument "-q".
748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007493.4. Userlists
750--------------
751It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
752http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
753it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
754
755userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100756 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100757 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
758
759group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100760 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100761 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
762 proceeded by "users" keyword.
763
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100764user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
765 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100766 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
767 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100768 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
769 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100770 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
771 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
772
773
774 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100775 userlist L1
776 group G1 users tiger,scott
777 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100778
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100779 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
780 user scott insecure-password elgato
781 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100782
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100783 userlist L2
784 group G1
785 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100786
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100787 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
788 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
789 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100790
791 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007934. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200794----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100795
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
797 - defaults <name>
798 - frontend <name>
799 - backend <name>
800 - listen <name>
801
802A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
803its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
804section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100805section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200806
807A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
808connections.
809
810A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
811to forward incoming connections.
812
813A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
814parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100816All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
817'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
818case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
819
820Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
821logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
822proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
823However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
824name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
825
826Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
827and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100828bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100829protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
830modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
831arbitrary criteria.
832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008344.1. Proxy keywords matrix
835--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100836
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200837The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
838limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
839they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
840limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100841marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200842option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200843and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
844with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
845specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100848 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
849------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
850acl - X X X
851appsession - - X X
852backlog X X X -
853balance X - X X
854bind - X X -
855bind-process X X X X
856block - X X X
857capture cookie - X X -
858capture request header - X X -
859capture response header - X X -
860clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
861contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
862cookie X - X X
863default-server X - X X
864default_backend X X X -
865description - X X X
866disabled X X X X
867dispatch - - X X
868enabled X X X X
869errorfile X X X X
870errorloc X X X X
871errorloc302 X X X X
872-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
873errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200874force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100875fullconn X - X X
876grace X X X X
877hash-type X - X X
878http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100879http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200880http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100881http-request - X X X
882id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200883ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100884log X X X X
885maxconn X X X -
886mode X X X X
887monitor fail - X X -
888monitor-net X X X -
889monitor-uri X X X -
890option abortonclose (*) X - X X
891option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
892option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
893option allbackups (*) X - X X
894option checkcache (*) X - X X
895option clitcpka (*) X X X -
896option contstats (*) X X X -
897option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
898option dontlognull (*) X X X -
899option forceclose (*) X X X X
900-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
901option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200902option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100903option http-server-close (*) X X X X
904option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
905option httpchk X - X X
906option httpclose (*) X X X X
907option httplog X X X X
908option http_proxy (*) X X X X
909option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200910option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100911option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
912option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
913option logasap (*) X X X -
914option mysql-check X - X X
915option nolinger (*) X X X X
916option originalto X X X X
917option persist (*) X - X X
918option redispatch (*) X - X X
919option smtpchk X - X X
920option socket-stats (*) X X X -
921option splice-auto (*) X X X X
922option splice-request (*) X X X X
923option splice-response (*) X X X X
924option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
925option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
926-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
927option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
928option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
929option tcpka X X X X
930option tcplog X X X X
931option transparent (*) X - X X
932persist rdp-cookie X - X X
933rate-limit sessions X X X -
934redirect - X X X
935redisp (deprecated) X - X X
936redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
937reqadd - X X X
938reqallow - X X X
939reqdel - X X X
940reqdeny - X X X
941reqiallow - X X X
942reqidel - X X X
943reqideny - X X X
944reqipass - X X X
945reqirep - X X X
946reqisetbe - X X X
947reqitarpit - X X X
948reqpass - X X X
949reqrep - X X X
950-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
951reqsetbe - X X X
952reqtarpit - X X X
953retries X - X X
954rspadd - X X X
955rspdel - X X X
956rspdeny - X X X
957rspidel - X X X
958rspideny - X X X
959rspirep - X X X
960rsprep - X X X
961server - - X X
962source X - X X
963srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +0200964stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100965stats auth X - X X
966stats enable X - X X
967stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200968stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100969stats realm X - X X
970stats refresh X - X X
971stats scope X - X X
972stats show-desc X - X X
973stats show-legends X - X X
974stats show-node X - X X
975stats uri X - X X
976-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
977stick match - - X X
978stick on - - X X
979stick store-request - - X X
980stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200981tcp-request connection - X X -
982tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +0200983tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100984timeout check X - X X
985timeout client X X X -
986timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
987timeout connect X - X X
988timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
989timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
990timeout http-request X X X X
991timeout queue X - X X
992timeout server X - X X
993timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
994timeout tarpit X X X X
995transparent (deprecated) X - X X
996use_backend - X X -
997------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
998 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200999
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010014.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1002---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001003
1004This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1005
1006
1007acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1008 Declare or complete an access list.
1009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1010 no | yes | yes | yes
1011 Example:
1012 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1013 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1014 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001016 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001017
1018
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001019appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1020 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001021 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1023 no | no | yes | yes
1024 Arguments :
1025 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1026 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1027
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001028 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001029 checked in each cookie value.
1030
1031 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1032 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1033 milliseconds.
1034
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001035 request-learn
1036 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1037 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1038 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1039 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1040 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1041 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1042
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001043 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1044 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1045 data following this prefix.
1046
1047 Example :
1048 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1049
1050 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1051 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1052
1053 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1054 2 modes are currently supported :
1055 - path-parameters :
1056 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1057 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1058 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1059 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1060 - query-string :
1061 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1062 query string.
1063
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001064 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1065 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1066 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1067 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001068 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1069 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1070 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001071 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1072 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1073
1074 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1075
1076 Example :
1077 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1078
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001079 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001080 and "ignore-persist"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001081
1082
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001083backlog <conns>
1084 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1086 yes | yes | yes | no
1087 Arguments :
1088 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1089 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1090 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1091
1092 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1093 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1094 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1095 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1096 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1097 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1098 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1099 backlog parameter.
1100
1101 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1102 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1103 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1104
1105 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1106
1107
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001108balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001109balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001110 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1112 yes | no | yes | yes
1113 Arguments :
1114 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1115 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1116 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1117 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1118
1119 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1120 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1121 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1122 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001123 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1124 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1125 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1126 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1127 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1128 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1129 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1130 it, so that you don't worry.
1131
1132 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1133 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1134 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1135 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1136 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1137 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1138 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1139 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001140
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001141 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1142 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1143 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1144 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1145 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1146 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1147 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1148 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1149
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001150 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1151 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1152 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1153 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1154 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1155 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1156 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1157 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001158 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001159 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001160 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1161 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1162 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001163
1164 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1165 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1166 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1167 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1168 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1169 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1170 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001171 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1172 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1173 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001174
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001175 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1176 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1177 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1178 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1179 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1180 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1181 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1182 URIs start with a leading "/".
1183
1184 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1185 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1186 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1187 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1188
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001189 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001190 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1191
1192 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1193 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1194 when the question mark indicating a query string ('?') is not
1195 present in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1196 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1197 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1198 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1199 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1200 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1201 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1202 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1203 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1204 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1205 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1206 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1207 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1208 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1209 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1210 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1211 be randomly balanced if at all.
1212
1213 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1214 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1215 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1216 server will receive the request.
1217
1218 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1219 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1220 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1221 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1222 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001223 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1224 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1225 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001226
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001227 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1228 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1229 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001230 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001231 algorithm is applied instead.
1232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001233 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001234 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1235 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1236 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1237
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001238 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1239 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1240 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1241
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001242 rdp-cookie
1243 rdp-cookie(name)
1244 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1245 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1246 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1247 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1248 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1249 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001250 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001251 used instead.
1252
1253 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1254 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1255 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1256 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1257
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001258 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1259 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1260 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001263 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1264 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001265
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001266 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001267 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001268
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001269 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1270 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1271 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001272
1273 Examples :
1274 balance roundrobin
1275 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001276 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001277 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1278 balance hdr(host)
1279 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001280
1281 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1282 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001284 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001285 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1286 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1287 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1288 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1289
1290 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1291 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1292 defaults to 16 kB.
1293
1294 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1295 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1296
1297 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1298 Round Robin.
1299
1300 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1301 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1302 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1303 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1304
1305 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1306
1307 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001308 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001309 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1310 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1311 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001312
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001313 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1314 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001315
1316
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001317bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1318bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1319bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1320bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1321bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1322bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1323bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001324 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1326 no | yes | yes | no
1327 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001328 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1329 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1330 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1331 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
1332 special address "0.0.0.0".
1333
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001334 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1335 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
1336 above. The port is mandatory. Note that in the case of an
1337 IPv6 address, the port is always the number after the last
1338 colon (':'). A range can either be :
1339 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1340 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1341 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1342 the range.
1343
1344 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1345 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1346 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1347 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1348 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1349 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1350 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1351 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1352 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001353
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001354 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1355 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1356 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1357 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1358 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1359 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1360 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1361 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
1362 privileges.
1363
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001364 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1365 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1366 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1367 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1368 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1369 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
1370 work on other operating systems. The commonly advertised
1371 value on Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP).
1372
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001373 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1374 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1375 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1376 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001377
1378 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1379
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001380 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1381 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1382 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001383 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001384 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1385 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1386 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1387 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
1388 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001389
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001390 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001391 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1392 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1393 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1394 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1395 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1396 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1397 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1398 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1399 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1400 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1401 with front firewalls which would see an established
1402 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001404 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1405 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1406 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1407 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1408 in a frontend.
1409
1410 Example :
1411 listen http_proxy
1412 bind :80,:443
1413 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
1414
1415 See also : "source".
1416
1417
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001418bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1419 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1421 yes | yes | yes | yes
1422 Arguments :
1423 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1424 may be used to override a default value.
1425
1426 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1427 option may be combined with other numbers.
1428
1429 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1430 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1431 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1432 missing from all processes.
1433
1434 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1435 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1436 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1437 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1438
1439 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1440 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1441 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1442 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1443 and 'even' instances.
1444
1445 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1446 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1447 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1448 32.
1449
1450 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1451 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1452
1453 Example :
1454 listen app_ip1
1455 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001456 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001457
1458 listen app_ip2
1459 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001460 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001461
1462 listen management
1463 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001464 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001465
1466 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1467
1468
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001469block { if | unless } <condition>
1470 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1472 no | yes | yes | yes
1473
1474 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1475 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001476 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001477 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1478 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1479 "block" statements per instance.
1480
1481 Example:
1482 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1483 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1484 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1485 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001487 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001488
1489
1490capture cookie <name> len <length>
1491 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1493 no | yes | yes | no
1494 Arguments :
1495 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1496 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1497 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1498 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1499 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1500
1501 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1502 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1503 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1504 right if it exceeds <length>.
1505
1506 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1507 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1508 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1509 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1510
1511 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1512 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1513 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1514
1515 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1516 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1517 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1518 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001519 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001520 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1521
1522 Example:
1523 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1524
1525 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001526 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001527
1528
1529capture request header <name> len <length>
1530 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1532 no | yes | yes | no
1533 Arguments :
1534 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001535 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001536 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1537 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1538 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1539
1540 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1541 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1542 it exceeds <length>.
1543
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001544 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001545 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1546 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001547 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1548 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1549 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1550 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001551 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001552 environments to find where the request came from.
1553
1554 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1555 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1556 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1557 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001558
1559 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1560 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1561 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1562 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1563
1564 Example:
1565 capture request header Host len 15
1566 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1567 capture request header Referrer len 15
1568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001569 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570 about logging.
1571
1572
1573capture response header <name> len <length>
1574 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1576 no | yes | yes | no
1577 Arguments :
1578 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001579 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001580 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1581 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1582 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1583
1584 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1585 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1586 it exceeds <length>.
1587
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001588 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001589 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1590 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1591 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001592 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1593 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1594 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1595 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001596
1597 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1598 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1599 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1600 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1601
1602 Example:
1603 capture response header Content-length len 9
1604 capture response header Location len 15
1605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001606 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001607 about logging.
1608
1609
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001610clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001611 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1613 yes | yes | yes | no
1614 Arguments :
1615 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1617 as explained at the top of this document.
1618
1619 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1620 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1621 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1622 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1623 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1624 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1625 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1626 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001627 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001628 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1629 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1630
1631 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1632 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1633 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1634 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1635 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1636 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1637
1638 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1639 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1640
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001641 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1642 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001643
1644
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001645contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1648 yes | no | yes | yes
1649 Arguments :
1650 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1651 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1652 as explained at the top of this document.
1653
1654 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001655 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001656 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001657 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1658 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1659 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1660 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1661
1662 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1663 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1664 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1665 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1666 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1667 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1668
1669 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1670 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1671 instead.
1672
1673 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1674 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1675
1676
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001677cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001678 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001679 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001680 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1682 yes | no | yes | yes
1683 Arguments :
1684 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1685 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1686 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1687 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1688 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1689 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1690 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1691 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1692 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1693
1694 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1695 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1696 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1697 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1698 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1699 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1700 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1701 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1702 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1703 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1704 "insert" and "prefix".
1705
1706 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001707 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001708
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001709 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001710 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1711 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1712 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1713 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1714 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1715 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1716 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1717 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1718 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1719 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720
1721 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1722 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1723 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1724 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1725 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1726 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1727 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1728 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1729 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1730 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1731 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1732
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001733 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1734 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1735 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001736 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1737 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1738 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1739 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001740
1741 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1742 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1743 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1744 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1745 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1746 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1747 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1748 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1749 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1750
1751 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1752 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1753 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1754 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1755 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1756 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1757 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1758 persistence cookie in the cache.
1759 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1760
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001761 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1762 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1763 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1764 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1765 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1766 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1767 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1768 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1769 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1770 they logout.
1771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001772 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001773 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001774 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1775 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1776 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1777 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1778 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1779 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001780
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001781 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1782 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1783 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1784 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1785 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1786 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1787 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1788 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1789 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1790 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1791 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1792 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1793 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1794 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1795 the site.
1796
1797 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1798 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1799 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1800 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1801 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1802 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1803 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1804 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1805 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1806 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1807 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1808 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1809 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1810 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1811 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1812 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1813
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1815 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1816 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1817 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819 Examples :
1820 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1821 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1822 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001823 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001824
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001825 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001826 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001827
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001829default-server [param*]
1830 Change default options for a server in a backend
1831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1832 yes | no | yes | yes
1833 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001834 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1835 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1836 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1837 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001838
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001839 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001840 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1841
1842 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001844
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001845default_backend <backend>
1846 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1848 yes | yes | yes | no
1849 Arguments :
1850 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1851
1852 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1853 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1854 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1855 will catch all undetermined requests.
1856
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857 Example :
1858
1859 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
1860 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
1861 default_backend dynamic
1862
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001863 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
1864
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001865
1866disabled
1867 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1869 yes | yes | yes | yes
1870 Arguments : none
1871
1872 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
1873 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
1874 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
1875 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
1876 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
1877 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
1878 keyword in a "defaults" section.
1879
1880 See also : "enabled"
1881
1882
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02001883dispatch <address>:<port>
1884 Set a default server address
1885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1886 no | no | yes | yes
1887 Arguments : none
1888
1889 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
1890 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
1891 during start-up.
1892
1893 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
1894 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
1895 possible with normal servers.
1896
1897 The "disabled" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
1898 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
1899 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
1900 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
1901 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
1902
1903 See also : "server"
1904
1905
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906enabled
1907 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1909 yes | yes | yes | yes
1910 Arguments : none
1911
1912 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
1913 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
1914
1915 See also : "disabled"
1916
1917
1918errorfile <code> <file>
1919 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1921 yes | yes | yes | yes
1922 Arguments :
1923 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1924 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1925
1926 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001927 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001928 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01001929 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
1930 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001931
1932 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
1933 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
1934 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
1935
1936 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
1937 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
1938 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
1939 files returning the same contents as default errors.
1940
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01001941 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
1942 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
1943 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
1944 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
1945 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
1946 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
1947
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001948 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
1949 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
1950 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01001951 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001952 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
1953
1954 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
1955
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01001956 Example :
1957 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
1958 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
1959 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
1960
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001961
1962errorloc <code> <url>
1963errorloc302 <code> <url>
1964 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1966 yes | yes | yes | yes
1967 Arguments :
1968 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1969 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1970
1971 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
1972 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
1973 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
1974 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
1975 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
1976
1977 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
1978 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
1979 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
1980
1981 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
1982 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
1983 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
1984 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
1985 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
1986 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
1987 request.
1988
1989 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
1990
1991
1992errorloc303 <code> <url>
1993 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1995 yes | yes | yes | yes
1996 Arguments :
1997 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1998 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1999
2000 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2001 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2002 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2003 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2004 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2005
2006 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2007 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2008 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2009
2010 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2011 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2012 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2013 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002014 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002015
2016 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2017
2018
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002019force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2020 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2022 no | yes | yes | yes
2023
2024 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2025 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2026 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2027 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2028 marked down for maintenance operations.
2029
2030 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2031 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2032 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2033 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2034 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2035 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2036 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2037 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2038 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2039
2040 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2041 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2042 is used.
2043
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002044 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002045 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002046
2047
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002048fullconn <conns>
2049 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2051 yes | no | yes | yes
2052 Arguments :
2053 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2054 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2055
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002056 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002057 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002058 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002059 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2060 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2061 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2062 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2063 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002064 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002065
2066 Example :
2067 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2068 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2069 # connections.
2070 backend dynamic
2071 fullconn 10000
2072 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2073 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2074
2075 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2076
2077
2078grace <time>
2079 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002081 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002082 Arguments :
2083 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2084 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2085 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2086
2087 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2088 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002089 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002090 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2091
2092 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2093 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2094 simplify it.
2095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002096
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002097hash-type <method>
2098 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2100 yes | no | yes | yes
2101 Arguments :
2102 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2103 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2104 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2105 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2106 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2107 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2108 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2109 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2110 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2111
2112 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2113 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2114 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2115 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2116 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2117 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2118 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2119 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2120 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2121 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2122 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2123 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2124 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2125
2126 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2127
2128 See also : "balance", "server"
2129
2130
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002131http-check disable-on-404
2132 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002134 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002135 Arguments : none
2136
2137 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2138 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2139 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2140 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2141 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2142 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2143 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2144 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002145 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2146 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2147 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2148
2149 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2150
2151
2152http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2153 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2155 no | no | yes | yes
2156 Arguments :
2157 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2158 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2159 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2160 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2161 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2162 details on the supported keywords.
2163
2164 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2165 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2166 with the usual backslash ('\').
2167
2168 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2169 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2170 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2171 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2172 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2173
2174 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2175 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2176 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2177 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2178 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2179
2180 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2181 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2182 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2183 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2184 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2185 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2186
2187 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2188 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2189 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2190 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2191 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2192 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2193 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2194 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2195 trace).
2196
2197 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2198 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2199 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2200 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2201 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2202 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2203 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2204 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2205
2206 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2207 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2208 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2209 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2210 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2211 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2212 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2213 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2214
2215 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2216 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2217
2218 Examples :
2219 # only accept status 200 as valid
2220 http-request expect status 200
2221
2222 # consider SQL errors as errors
2223 http-request expect ! string SQL\ Error
2224
2225 # consider status 5xx only as errors
2226 http-request expect ! rstatus ^5
2227
2228 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
2229 http-request expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002230
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002231 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002232
2233
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002234http-check send-state
2235 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2237 yes | no | yes | yes
2238 Arguments : none
2239
2240 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2241 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2242 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2243 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2244 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2245
2246 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2247 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2248 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2249 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2250 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2251 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2252 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2253 checked in multiple backends.
2254
2255 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2256 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2257
2258 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2259 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2260 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2261 one fails.
2262
2263 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2264 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2265 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2266
2267 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2268 server's queue.
2269
2270 Example of a header received by the application server :
2271 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2272 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2273
2274 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2275
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002276http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002277 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002278 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2279
2280 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2281 no | yes | yes | yes
2282
2283 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2284 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2285 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002286 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2287 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002288 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2289
2290 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2291 instance.
2292
2293 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002294 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2295 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2296 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002297
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002298 http-request allow if nagios
2299 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2300 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2301 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002302
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002303 Example:
2304 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002305
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002306 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002307
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002308 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2309 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002310
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002311id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002312 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2314 no | yes | yes | yes
2315 Arguments : none
2316
2317 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2318 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2319 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002320
2321
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002322ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2323 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2325 no | yes | yes | yes
2326
2327 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2328 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2329 and running).
2330
2331 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2332 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2333 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2334 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2335 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2336
2337 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2338 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2339
2340 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2341 "unless" condition is met.
2342
2343 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2344
2345
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002346log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002347log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002348 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2350 yes | yes | yes | yes
2351 Arguments :
2352 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2353 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2354 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2355 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2356 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2357 parameter.
2358
2359 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2360 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2361
2362 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2363 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2364 standard syslog port).
2365
2366 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2367 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2368 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2369 appropriately writeable).
2370
2371 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2372
2373 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2374 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2375 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2376
2377 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2378 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2379 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002380 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2381 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2382 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2383 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2384 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002385
2386 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2387
2388 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2389 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2390 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2391
2392 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002393 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2394 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2395 "info".
2396
2397 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2398 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2399 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2400 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2401
2402 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2403 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002404
2405 Example :
2406 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002407 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2408 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002409
2410
2411maxconn <conns>
2412 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2414 yes | yes | yes | no
2415 Arguments :
2416 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2417 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2418 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2419 closes.
2420
2421 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2422 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2423 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2424 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2425 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2426 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2427 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2428 properly tuned.
2429
2430 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2431 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2432 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2433
2434 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2435
2436
2437mode { tcp|http|health }
2438 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2440 yes | yes | yes | yes
2441 Arguments :
2442 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2443 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2444 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2445 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2446
2447 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2448 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2449 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2450 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2451 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2452
2453 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2454 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2455 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2456 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2457 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2458 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2459
2460 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2461 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2462 will be refused.
2463
2464 Example :
2465 defaults http_instances
2466 mode http
2467
2468 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002470
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002471monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002472 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2474 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002475 Arguments :
2476 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2477 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002478 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002479 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2480 backend and its backup.
2481
2482 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2483 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2484 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2485 servers in a list of backends.
2486
2487 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2488 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2489 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2490 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2491 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2492 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2493 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002494 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495
2496 Example:
2497 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002498 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2500 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2501 monitor-uri /site_alive
2502 monitor fail if site_dead
2503
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002504 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri"
2505
2506
2507monitor-net <source>
2508 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2510 yes | yes | yes | no
2511 Arguments :
2512 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2513 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2514 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2515 followed by a mask.
2516
2517 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2518 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002519 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002520 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2521
2522 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2523 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2524 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2525 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2526 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2527
2528 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2529 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2530 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2531 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2532 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2533
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002534 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2535 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2536
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002537 Example :
2538 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2539 frontend www
2540 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2541
2542 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2543
2544
2545monitor-uri <uri>
2546 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2548 yes | yes | yes | no
2549 Arguments :
2550 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2551 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2552
2553 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2554 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2555 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2556 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2557 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2558 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2559 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2560 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2561
2562 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2563 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2564 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2565 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2566 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2567 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2568
2569 Example :
2570 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2571 frontend www
2572 mode http
2573 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2574
2575 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002577
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002578option abortonclose
2579no option abortonclose
2580 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2582 yes | no | yes | yes
2583 Arguments : none
2584
2585 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2586 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2587 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2588 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002589 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002590 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2591 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2592 encountered while delivering the response.
2593
2594 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2595 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2596 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2597 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2598 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2599 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002600 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002601 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002602 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002603 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2604 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2605 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2606
2607 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2608 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2609 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2610 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2611 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2612 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2613 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2614 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002615 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002616
2617 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2618 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2619
2620 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2621
2622
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002623option accept-invalid-http-request
2624no option accept-invalid-http-request
2625 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2627 yes | yes | yes | no
2628 Arguments : none
2629
2630 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2631 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2632 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2633 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2634 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2635 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2636 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2637 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2638 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2639
2640 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2641 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2642 been confirmed.
2643
2644 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2645 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2646 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2647 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2648
2649 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2650 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2651
2652 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2653 stats socket.
2654
2655
2656option accept-invalid-http-response
2657no option accept-invalid-http-response
2658 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2660 yes | no | yes | yes
2661 Arguments : none
2662
2663 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2664 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2665 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2666 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2667 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2668 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2669 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2670 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2671 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2672
2673 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2674 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2675 been confirmed.
2676
2677 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2678 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2679 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2680 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2681
2682 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2683 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2684
2685 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2686 stats socket.
2687
2688
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002689option allbackups
2690no option allbackups
2691 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2693 yes | no | yes | yes
2694 Arguments : none
2695
2696 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2697 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2698 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2699 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2700 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2701 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2702 order between the backup servers anymore.
2703
2704 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2705 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2706
2707 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2708 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2709
2710
2711option checkcache
2712no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002713 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2715 yes | no | yes | yes
2716 Arguments : none
2717
2718 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2719 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002720 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002721 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2722 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2723 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2724
2725 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002726 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002727 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002728 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2729 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002730 to the client are :
2731 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002732 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002733 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002734 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2735 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2736 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2737 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2738 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2739 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2740 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2741 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2742 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2743 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2744 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2745
2746 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002747 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002748 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002749 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002750 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2751
2752 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2753 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002754 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002755 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2756
2757 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2758 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2759
2760
2761option clitcpka
2762no option clitcpka
2763 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2765 yes | yes | yes | no
2766 Arguments : none
2767
2768 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2769 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2770 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2771 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2772
2773 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2774 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2775 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2776 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2777
2778 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2779 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2780 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2781 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2782 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2783
2784 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2785
2786 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2787 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2788 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2789
2790 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2791 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2792
2793 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2794
2795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002796option contstats
2797 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2799 yes | yes | yes | no
2800 Arguments : none
2801
2802 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2803 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2804 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2805 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2806 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2807 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2808 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2809
2810
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002811option dontlog-normal
2812no option dontlog-normal
2813 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2815 yes | yes | yes | no
2816 Arguments : none
2817
2818 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2819 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2820 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
2821 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
2822 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
2823 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
2824 logged.
2825
2826 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
2827 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
2828 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
2829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002830 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002831 logging.
2832
2833
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002834option dontlognull
2835no option dontlognull
2836 Enable or disable logging of null connections
2837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2838 yes | yes | yes | no
2839 Arguments : none
2840
2841 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
2842 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
2843 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
2844 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
2845 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
2846 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
2847 which typically corresponds to those probes.
2848
2849 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
2850 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
2851 would not be logged.
2852
2853 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2854 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002856 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002857
2858
2859option forceclose
2860no option forceclose
2861 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
2862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01002863 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002864 Arguments : none
2865
2866 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
2867 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
2868 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
2869 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
2870 global session times in the logs.
2871
2872 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01002873 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01002874 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
2875 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
2876 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
2877 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002878
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002879 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
2880 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
2881 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
2882
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002883 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2884 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2885
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002886 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002887
2888
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002889option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002890 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
2891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2892 yes | yes | yes | yes
2893 Arguments :
2894 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
2895 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002896 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002897 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002898
2899 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
2900 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
2901 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
2902 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
2903 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
2904 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
2905 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002906 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
2907 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
2908 possible that the client has already brought one.
2909
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002910 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002911 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002912 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
2913 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002914 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
2915 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002916
2917 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
2918 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
2919 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
2920 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
2921 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
2922 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
2923 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
2924
2925 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002926 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
2927 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
2928 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002929
2930 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
2931 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
2932 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
2933 when using this option.
2934
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002935 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002936 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
2937 frontend www
2938 mode http
2939 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
2940
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002941 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
2942 backend www
2943 mode http
2944 option forwardfor header X-Client
2945
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002946 See also : "option httpclose"
2947
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002948
2949option http-pretend-keepalive
2950no option http-pretend-keepalive
2951 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
2952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2953 yes | yes | yes | yes
2954 Arguments : none
2955
2956 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
2957 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
2958 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
2959 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
2960 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
2961 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
2962 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
2963 consider the response complete.
2964
2965 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
2966 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
2967 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
2968 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
2969 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
2970 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
2971
2972 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
2973 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
2974 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
2975 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
2976 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
2977 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
2978 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
2979
2980 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
2981 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02002982 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
2983 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
2984 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002985
2986 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2987 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2988
2989 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
2990
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002991
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01002992option http-server-close
2993no option http-server-close
2994 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
2995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2996 yes | yes | yes | yes
2997 Arguments : none
2998
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02002999 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3000 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3001 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3002 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3003 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3004 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3005 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3006 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3007 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3008 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3009 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3010 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003011
3012 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3013 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3014 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3015 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003016 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3017 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003018
3019 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3020 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003021 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3022 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3023 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003024
3025 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3026 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3027
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003028 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3029 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003030
3031
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003032option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003033no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003034 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3036 yes | yes | yes | no
3037 Arguments : none
3038
3039 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3040 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3041 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3042 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3043 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3044 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3045 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3046
3047 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3048 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3049 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3050 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3051 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3052 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3053 request along its whole life.
3054
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003055 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3056 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3057 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3058 front of an existing proxy.
3059
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003060 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3061
3062 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3063 http-server-close".
3064
3065
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003066option httpchk
3067option httpchk <uri>
3068option httpchk <method> <uri>
3069option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3070 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3072 yes | no | yes | yes
3073 Arguments :
3074 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3075 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3076 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3077 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3078 ones.
3079
3080 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3081 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3082 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3083
3084 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3085 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3086 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3087 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3088 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3089
3090 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3091 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3092 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3093 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3094 the lack of any response.
3095
3096 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3097
3098 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3099 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3100 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3101
3102 Examples :
3103 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3104 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3105 backend https_relay
3106 mode tcp
3107 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3108 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3109
3110 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
3111 "http-check" and the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
3112
3113
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003114option httpclose
3115no option httpclose
3116 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3118 yes | yes | yes | yes
3119 Arguments : none
3120
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003121 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3122 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3123 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3124 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3125 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3126 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3127 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003128
3129 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003130 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3131 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3132 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3133 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3134 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3135 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003136
3137 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3138 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3139 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003140 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3141 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003142
3143 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3144 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3145
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003146 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3147 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003148
3149
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003150option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003151 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3153 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003154 Arguments :
3155 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3156 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3157 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3158 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3159 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003160
3161 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3162 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3163 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3164 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3165 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3166 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3167 ports.
3168
3169 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3170
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003171 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3172 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3173 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3174 by default.
3175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003176 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003177
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003178
3179option http_proxy
3180no option http_proxy
3181 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3183 yes | yes | yes | yes
3184 Arguments : none
3185
3186 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3187 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3188 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3189 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3190 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3191
3192 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3193 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3194 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3195 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
3196 needed to add "option http_close" to ensure that all requests will correctly
3197 be analyzed.
3198
3199 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3200 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3201
3202 Example :
3203 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3204 backend direct_forward
3205 option httpclose
3206 option http_proxy
3207
3208 See also : "option httpclose"
3209
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003210
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003211option ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3212 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3214 no | yes | yes | yes
3215
3216 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3217 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3218 and running).
3219
3220 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3221 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3222 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3223 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3224 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3225
3226 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3227 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3228
3229 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3230 "unless" condition is met.
3231
3232 See also : "option force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3233
3234
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003235option independant-streams
3236no option independant-streams
3237 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3239 yes | yes | yes | yes
3240 Arguments : none
3241
3242 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3243 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3244 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3245 receive data or not.
3246
3247 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3248 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3249 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3250 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3251 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3252 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3253 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3254 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3255 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3256 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3257 socket buffers.
3258
3259 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3260 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3261 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3262 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3263 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3264
3265 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3266
3267
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003268option ldap-check
3269 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3271 yes | no | yes | yes
3272 Arguments : none
3273
3274 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3275 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3276 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3277 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3278
3279 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3280 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3281
3282 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3283 configure it.
3284
3285 Example :
3286 option ldap-check
3287
3288 See also : "option httpchk"
3289
3290
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003291option log-health-checks
3292no option log-health-checks
3293 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3295 yes | no | yes | yes
3296 Arguments : none
3297
3298 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3299 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3300 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3301 of additional information is limited.
3302
3303 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3304 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3305
3306 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3307
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003308
3309option log-separate-errors
3310no option log-separate-errors
3311 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3313 yes | yes | yes | no
3314 Arguments : none
3315
3316 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3317 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3318 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3319 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3320 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3321 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3322 provides very important information.
3323
3324 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3325 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3326 error logs.
3327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003328 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003329 logging.
3330
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003331
3332option logasap
3333no option logasap
3334 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3336 yes | yes | yes | no
3337 Arguments : none
3338
3339 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3340 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3341 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3342 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3343 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3344 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3345 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003346 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003347 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3348 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3349
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003350 Examples :
3351 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3352 mode http
3353 option httplog
3354 option logasap
3355 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3356
3357 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3358 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3359 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3360 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003362 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003363 logging.
3364
3365
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003366option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3367 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3369 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003370 Arguments :
3371 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3372 to MySQL server.
3373
3374 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3375 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3376 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3377 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3378 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3379 in the MySQL table, like this :
3380
3381 USE mysql;
3382 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3383 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3384
3385 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3386 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3387 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3388 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3389 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3390 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3391 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3392 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3393 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3394
3395 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3396 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003397
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003398 The check requires MySQL >=4.0, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003399
3400 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3401 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3402 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3403 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3404 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3405 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3406
3407 See also: "option httpchk"
3408
3409
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003410option nolinger
3411no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003412 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003413 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3414 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003415 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003416
3417 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3418 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3419 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3420 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3421 connections.
3422
3423 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3424 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3425 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3426 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3427 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3428 this too.
3429
3430 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3431 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3432 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3433
3434 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3435 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3436 for servers.
3437
3438 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3439 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3440
3441
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003442option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3443 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3445 yes | yes | yes | yes
3446 Arguments :
3447 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3448 matching <network>
3449 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3450 header name.
3451
3452 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3453 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3454 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3455 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3456 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3457 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3458 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3459 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3460 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3461 possible that the client has already brought one.
3462
3463 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3464 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3465 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3466 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3467 header and requires different one.
3468
3469 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3470 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3471 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3472 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3473 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3474 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3475 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3476
3477 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3478 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3479 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3480 both are defined.
3481
3482 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3483 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3484 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3485 when using this option.
3486
3487 Examples :
3488 # Original Destination address
3489 frontend www
3490 mode http
3491 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3492
3493 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3494 backend www
3495 mode http
3496 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3497
3498 See also : "option httpclose"
3499
3500
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003501option persist
3502no option persist
3503 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3504 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3505 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003506 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003507
3508 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3509 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3510 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3511 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3512 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3513 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3514 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3515 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3516 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3517 redirected to another valid server.
3518
3519 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3520 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3521
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003522 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003523
3524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003525option redispatch
3526no option redispatch
3527 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3528 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3529 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003530 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003531
3532 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3533 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3534 be able to access the service anymore.
3535
3536 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3537 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3538
3539 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3540 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3541 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003542
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003543 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3544 "redisp" keywords.
3545
3546 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3547 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3548
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003549 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003550
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003551
3552option smtpchk
3553option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3554 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3556 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003557 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003558 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3559 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3560 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3561
3562 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3563 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3564 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3565
3566 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3567 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3568 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3569 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3570 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3571 dead server.
3572
3573 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3574 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3575 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3576 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3577
3578 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3579 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3580 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3581 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3582 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3583
3584 Example :
3585 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3586
3587 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003590option socket-stats
3591no option socket-stats
3592
3593 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3595 yes | yes | yes | no
3596
3597 Arguments : none
3598
3599
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003600option splice-auto
3601no option splice-auto
3602 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 yes | yes | yes | yes
3605 Arguments : none
3606
3607 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3608 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3609 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3610 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003611 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003612 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3613 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3614 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3615 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3616
3617 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3618 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3619 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3620 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3621 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3622 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3623 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3624 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3625 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3626 keyword.
3627
3628 Example :
3629 option splice-auto
3630
3631 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3632 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3633
3634 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3635 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3636
3637
3638option splice-request
3639no option splice-request
3640 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3642 yes | yes | yes | yes
3643 Arguments : none
3644
3645 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3646 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3647 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3648 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3649 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3650 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3651
3652 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3653
3654 Example :
3655 option splice-request
3656
3657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3659
3660 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3661 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3662
3663
3664option splice-response
3665no option splice-response
3666 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 yes | yes | yes | yes
3669 Arguments : none
3670
3671 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3672 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3673 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3674 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3675 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3676 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3677
3678 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3679
3680 Example :
3681 option splice-response
3682
3683 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3684 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3685
3686 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3687 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3688
3689
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003690option srvtcpka
3691no option srvtcpka
3692 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3694 yes | no | yes | yes
3695 Arguments : none
3696
3697 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3698 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3699 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3700 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3701
3702 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3703 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3704 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3705 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3706
3707 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3708 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3709 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3710 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3711 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3712
3713 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3714
3715 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3716 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3717 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3718
3719 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3720 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3721
3722 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3723
3724
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003725option ssl-hello-chk
3726 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3728 yes | no | yes | yes
3729 Arguments : none
3730
3731 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3732 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3733 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3734 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3735 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3736 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3737 hello message.
3738
3739 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3740 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3741 messages, which is appreciable.
3742
3743 See also: "option httpchk"
3744
3745
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003746option tcp-smart-accept
3747no option tcp-smart-accept
3748 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3750 yes | yes | yes | no
3751 Arguments : none
3752
3753 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3754 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3755 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3756 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3757 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3758 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3759
3760 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3761 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3762 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3763 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3764
3765 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3766 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3767 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3768 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3769
3770 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3771 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3772 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3773
3774 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3775 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3776 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3777
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003778 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3779
3780
3781option tcp-smart-connect
3782no option tcp-smart-connect
3783 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3785 yes | no | yes | yes
3786 Arguments : none
3787
3788 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3789 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3790 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3791 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3792 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3793
3794 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3795 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3796 complex.
3797
3798 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
3799 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
3800 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
3801
3802 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3803 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3804
3805 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
3806
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003807
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003808option tcpka
3809 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
3810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3811 yes | yes | yes | yes
3812 Arguments : none
3813
3814 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3815 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3816 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3817 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3818
3819 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3820 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3821 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3822 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3823
3824 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3825 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3826 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3827 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3828 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3829
3830 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3831
3832 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
3833 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
3834 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
3835 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
3836 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
3837 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
3838 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
3839 backends.
3840
3841 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
3842
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003843
3844option tcplog
3845 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
3846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3847 yes | yes | yes | yes
3848 Arguments : none
3849
3850 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3851 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3852 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
3853 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
3854 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
3855 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
3856 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
3857 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
3858
3859 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3860
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003861 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003862
3863
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003864option transparent
3865no option transparent
3866 Enable client-side transparent proxying
3867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01003868 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003869 Arguments : none
3870
3871 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
3872 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
3873 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
3874 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
3875 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
3876 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
3877 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
3878 appropriate server.
3879
3880 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
3881 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
3882
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003883 See also: the "usersrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
3884 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003885
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003886
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003887persist rdp-cookie
3888persist rdp-cookie(name)
3889 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
3890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3891 yes | no | yes | yes
3892 Arguments :
3893 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02003894 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
3895 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003896
3897 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
3898 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
3899 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
3900 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
3901 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
3902 forwarded to this server.
3903
3904 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
3905 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
3906 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003907 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003908 a single "listen" section.
3909
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02003910 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
3911 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
3912 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
3913
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003914 Example :
3915 listen tse-farm
3916 bind :3389
3917 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
3918 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
3919 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
3920 # apply RDP cookie persistence
3921 persist rdp-cookie
3922 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
3923 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
3924 balance rdp-cookie
3925 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
3926 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
3927
3928 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
3929
3930
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01003931rate-limit sessions <rate>
3932 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
3933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | no
3935 Arguments :
3936 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
3937 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
3938
3939 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
3940 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
3941 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
3942 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
3943 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
3944 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
3945
3946 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
3947 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
3948 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
3949 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
3950
3951 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
3952 listen smtp
3953 mode tcp
3954 bind :25
3955 rate-limit sessions 10
3956 server 127.0.0.1:1025
3957
3958 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
3959 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
3960
3961 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
3962
3963
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01003964redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
3965redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003966 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3968 no | yes | yes | yes
3969
3970 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01003971 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003972
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003973 Arguments :
3974 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
3975 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
3976 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
3977 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01003978 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
3979 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
3980 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
3981 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003982
3983 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
3984 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
3985 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
3986 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
3987 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
3988 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
3989 location with a GET method.
3990
3991 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
3992 expected behaviour of a redirection :
3993
3994 - "drop-query"
3995 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
3996 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
3997 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
3998 with a location-type redirect.
3999
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004000 - "append-slash"
4001 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4002 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4003 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4004 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4005
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004006 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4007 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4008 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4009 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4010 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4011 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4012 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4013
4014 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4015 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4016 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4017 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4018 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4019 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4020 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004021
4022 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4023 acl clear dst_port 80
4024 acl secure dst_port 8080
4025 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004026 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004027 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004028 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4029
4030 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004031 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4032 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4033 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004034 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004035
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004036 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4037 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4038 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004040 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004041
4042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004043redisp (deprecated)
4044redispatch (deprecated)
4045 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4046 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4047 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004048 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004049
4050 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4051 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4052 be able to access the service anymore.
4053
4054 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4055 redistribute them to a working server.
4056
4057 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4058 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4059 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004061 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4062 "option redispatch" instead.
4063
4064 See also : "option redispatch"
4065
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004066
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004067reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004068 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4070 no | yes | yes | yes
4071 Arguments :
4072 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4073 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004074 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004075
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004076 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4077 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4078
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004079 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4080 the last header of an HTTP request.
4081
4082 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4083 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4084 responses.
4085
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004086 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4087 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4088 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4089
4090 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4091 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004092
4093
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004094reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4095reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004096 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4098 no | yes | yes | yes
4099 Arguments :
4100 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4101 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4102 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4103 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4104 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4105 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4106 ignores case.
4107
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004108 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4109 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4110
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004111 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4112 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4113 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4114 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004115 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004116
4117 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4118 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4119
4120 Example :
4121 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4122 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4123 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4124
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004125 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4126 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004127
4128
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004129reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4130reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004131 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4133 no | yes | yes | yes
4134 Arguments :
4135 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4136 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4137 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4138 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4139 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4140 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4141
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004142 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4143 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4144
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004145 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4146 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4147 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4148 next servers.
4149
4150 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4151 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4152 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4153
4154 Example :
4155 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4156 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4157 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4158
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004159 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4160 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004161
4162
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004163reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4164reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004165 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4167 no | yes | yes | yes
4168 Arguments :
4169 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4170 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4171 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4172 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4173 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4174 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4175 case.
4176
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004177 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4178 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4179
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004180 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4181 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4182 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4183 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004184 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004185
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004186 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004187 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004188 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004189
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004190 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4191 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4192
4193 Example :
4194 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4195 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4196 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4197
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004198 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4199 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004200
4201
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004202reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4203reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004204 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4206 no | yes | yes | yes
4207 Arguments :
4208 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4209 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4210 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4211 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4212 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4213 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4214 case.
4215
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004216 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4217 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4218
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004219 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4220 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4221 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4222 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4223
4224 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4225 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4226
4227 Example :
4228 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4229 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4230 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4231 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4232
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004233 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4234 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004235
4236
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004237reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4238reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004239 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4241 no | yes | yes | yes
4242 Arguments :
4243 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4244 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4245 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4246 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4247 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4248 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4249
4250 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4251 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4252 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4253 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004254 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004255
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004256 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4257 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4258
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004259 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4260 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4261 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4262
4263 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4264 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4265 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4266 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4267 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4268
4269 Example :
4270 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4271 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4272 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4273 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4274
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004275 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4276 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004277
4278
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004279reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4280reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004281 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 no | yes | yes | yes
4284 Arguments :
4285 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4286 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4287 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4288 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4289 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4290 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4291 ignores case.
4292
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004293 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4294 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4295
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004296 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4297 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004298 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4299 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4300 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004301 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4302 not set.
4303
4304 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4305 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4306 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4307 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4308 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4309
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004310 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004311 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4312 # block all others.
4313 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4314 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4315
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004316 # block bad guys
4317 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4318 reqitarpit . if badguys
4319
4320 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4321 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004322
4323
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004324retries <value>
4325 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4326 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4327 yes | no | yes | yes
4328 Arguments :
4329 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4330 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4331 default value is 3.
4332
4333 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4334 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4335 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4336
4337 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4338 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4339
4340 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4341 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4342
4343 See also : "option redispatch"
4344
4345
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004346rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004347 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4349 no | yes | yes | yes
4350 Arguments :
4351 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4352 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004353 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004354
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004355 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4356 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4357
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004358 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4359 the last header of an HTTP response.
4360
4361 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4362 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4363 responses.
4364
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004365 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4366 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004367
4368
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004369rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4370rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004371 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4373 no | yes | yes | yes
4374 Arguments :
4375 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4376 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4377 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4378 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4379 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4380 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4381 ignores case.
4382
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004383 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4384 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4385
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004386 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4387 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4388 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4389 client.
4390
4391 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4392 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4393 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4394
4395 Example :
4396 # remove the Server header from responses
4397 reqidel ^Server:.*
4398
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004399 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4400 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004401
4402
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004403rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4404rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004405 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4407 no | yes | yes | yes
4408 Arguments :
4409 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4410 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4411 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4412 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4413 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4414 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4415 ignores case.
4416
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004417 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4418 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4419
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004420 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4421 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4422 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4423 case-sensitive.
4424
4425 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004426 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4427 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4428 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004429
4430 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4431 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4432
4433 Example :
4434 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4435 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4436
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004437 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4438 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004439
4440
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004441rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4442rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004443 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4445 no | yes | yes | yes
4446 Arguments :
4447 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4448 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4449 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4450 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4451 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4452 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4453 ignores case.
4454
4455 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4456 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4457 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4458 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004459 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004460
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004461 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4462 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4463
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004464 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4465 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4466 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4467
4468 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4469 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4470 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4471 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4472 are not case-sensitive.
4473
4474 Example :
4475 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4476 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4477
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004478 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4479 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004480
4481
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004482server <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
4483 Declare a server in a backend
4484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4485 no | no | yes | yes
4486 Arguments :
4487 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4488 appear in logs and alerts.
4489
4490 <address> is the IPv4 address of the server. Alternatively, a resolvable
4491 hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved during
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004492 start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning. It
4493 indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
4494 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4495 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4496 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4497 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4498 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4499 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004500
4501 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4502 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4503 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4504 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4505 adding this value to the client's port.
4506
4507 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4508 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004509 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004510
4511 Examples :
4512 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4513 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004515 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004516
4517
4518source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004519source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004520source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004521 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4523 yes | no | yes | yes
4524 Arguments :
4525 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4526 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4527 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4528 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4529
4530 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4531 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004532 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4533 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4534 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004535
4536 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4537 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4538 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4539 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4540 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4541 <addr>.
4542
4543 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4544 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4545 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4546 port.
4547
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004548 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4549 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4550 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4551 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4552 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4553 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4554 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4555 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4556 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4557 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4558 HTTP header.
4559
4560 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4561 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4562 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4563 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4564 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4565 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4566 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4567 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4568 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4569 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4570
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004571 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4572 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4573 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4574 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4575 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4576 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4577
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004578 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4579 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4580 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4581 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4582
4583 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4584 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4585 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4586 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4587 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4588 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4589
4590 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4591 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4592 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4593 there are two methods :
4594
4595 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4596 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4597 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4598 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4599 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4600 of the client ranges may be used.
4601
4602 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4603 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4604 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4605 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4606 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4607 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4608 same session.
4609
4610 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4611 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4612 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4613 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4614 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4615 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4616
4617 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4618 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4619 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004620 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004621
4622 Examples :
4623 backend private
4624 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4625 source 192.168.1.200
4626
4627 backend transparent_ssl1
4628 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4629 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4630
4631 backend transparent_ssl2
4632 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4633 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4634 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4635
4636 backend transparent_ssl3
4637 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4638 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4639 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4640
4641 backend transparent_smtp
4642 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4643 # with Tproxy version 4.
4644 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4645
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004646 backend transparent_http
4647 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4648 # proxy.
4649 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004651 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004652 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004654
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004655srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4656 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4658 yes | no | yes | yes
4659 Arguments :
4660 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4661 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4662 as explained at the top of this document.
4663
4664 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4665 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4666 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4667 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4668 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4669 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4670 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4671
4672 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4673 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4674 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4675 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4676 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004677 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004678 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004679 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004680
4681 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4682 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4683 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4684 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4685 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4686 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4687
4688 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4689 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4690
4691 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4692
4693
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004694stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4695 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4697 no | no | yes | yes
4698
4699 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4700 matched.
4701
4702 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4703 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4704
4705 Currently, there are 2 known limitations :
4706
4707 - The POST data are limited to one packet, which means that if the list of
4708 servers is too long, the request won't be processed. It is recommended
4709 to alter few servers at a time.
4710
4711 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported.
4712
4713 Example :
4714 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4715 backend stats_localhost
4716 stats enable
4717 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4718
4719 Example :
4720 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4721 backend stats_auth
4722 stats enable
4723 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4724 stats admin if TRUE
4725
4726 Example :
4727 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4728 userlist stats-auth
4729 group admin users admin
4730 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4731 group readonly users haproxy
4732 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4733
4734 backend stats_auth
4735 stats enable
4736 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4737 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4738 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4739 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4740
4741 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
4742 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
4743
4744
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004745stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4746 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4748 yes | no | yes | yes
4749 Arguments :
4750 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4751
4752 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4753
4754 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4755 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4756 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4757 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4758 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4759 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4760
4761 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4762 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4763 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4764 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4765
4766 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4767 report using "stats scope".
4768
4769 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4770 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4771 unobvious parameters.
4772
4773 Example :
4774 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4775 backend public_www
4776 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4777 stats enable
4778 stats hide-version
4779 stats scope .
4780 stats uri /admin?stats
4781 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4782 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4783 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4784
4785 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4786 backend private_monitoring
4787 stats enable
4788 stats uri /admin?stats
4789 stats refresh 5s
4790
4791 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4792
4793
4794stats enable
4795 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
4796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4797 yes | no | yes | yes
4798 Arguments : none
4799
4800 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
4801 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
4802 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
4803 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
4804 - stats auth : no authentication
4805 - stats scope : no restriction
4806
4807 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4808 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4809 unobvious parameters.
4810
4811 Example :
4812 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4813 backend public_www
4814 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4815 stats enable
4816 stats hide-version
4817 stats scope .
4818 stats uri /admin?stats
4819 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4820 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4821 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4822
4823 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4824 backend private_monitoring
4825 stats enable
4826 stats uri /admin?stats
4827 stats refresh 5s
4828
4829 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4830
4831
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004832stats hide-version
4833 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4835 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004836 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004837
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004838 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
4839 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
4840 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
4841 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
4842 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
4843 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004845 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4846 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4847 unobvious parameters.
4848
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004849 Example :
4850 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4851 backend public_www
4852 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004853 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004854 stats hide-version
4855 stats scope .
4856 stats uri /admin?stats
4857 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4858 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4859 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004860
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004861 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4862 backend private_monitoring
4863 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004864 stats uri /admin?stats
4865 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01004866
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004867 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004868
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004869
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004870stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
4871 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4872 Access control for statistics
4873
4874 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4875 no | no | yes | yes
4876
4877 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
4878 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
4879 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
4880 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
4881 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
4882 should be asked to enter a username and password.
4883
4884 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
4885 instance.
4886
4887 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4888 about ACL usage.
4889
4890
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004891stats realm <realm>
4892 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
4893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4894 yes | no | yes | yes
4895 Arguments :
4896 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
4897 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
4898 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
4899
4900 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
4901 using a backslash ('\').
4902
4903 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
4904 only related to authentication.
4905
4906 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4907 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4908 unobvious parameters.
4909
4910 Example :
4911 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4912 backend public_www
4913 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4914 stats enable
4915 stats hide-version
4916 stats scope .
4917 stats uri /admin?stats
4918 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4919 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4920 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4921
4922 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4923 backend private_monitoring
4924 stats enable
4925 stats uri /admin?stats
4926 stats refresh 5s
4927
4928 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
4929
4930
4931stats refresh <delay>
4932 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
4933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | no | yes | yes
4935 Arguments :
4936 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
4937 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
4938 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
4939 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
4940 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
4941 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
4942
4943 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
4944 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
4945 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
4946 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
4947
4948 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4949 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4950 unobvious parameters.
4951
4952 Example :
4953 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4954 backend public_www
4955 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4956 stats enable
4957 stats hide-version
4958 stats scope .
4959 stats uri /admin?stats
4960 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4961 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4962 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4963
4964 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4965 backend private_monitoring
4966 stats enable
4967 stats uri /admin?stats
4968 stats refresh 5s
4969
4970 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4971
4972
4973stats scope { <name> | "." }
4974 Enable statistics and limit access scope
4975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4976 yes | no | yes | yes
4977 Arguments :
4978 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
4979 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
4980 section in which the statement appears.
4981
4982 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
4983 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
4984 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
4985 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
4986 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
4987 exists.
4988
4989 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4990 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4991 unobvious parameters.
4992
4993 Example :
4994 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4995 backend public_www
4996 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4997 stats enable
4998 stats hide-version
4999 stats scope .
5000 stats uri /admin?stats
5001 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5002 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5003 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5004
5005 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5006 backend private_monitoring
5007 stats enable
5008 stats uri /admin?stats
5009 stats refresh 5s
5010
5011 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5012
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005013
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005014stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005015 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 yes | no | yes | yes
5018
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005019 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005020 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5021
5022 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5023 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5024
5025 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5026 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5027 unobvious parameters.
5028
5029 Example :
5030 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5031 backend private_monitoring
5032 stats enable
5033 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5034 stats uri /admin?stats
5035 stats refresh 5s
5036
5037 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5038 global section.
5039
5040
5041stats show-legends
5042 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5043 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5044 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5045 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5046 - IP (socket, server)
5047 - cookie (backend, server)
5048
5049 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5050 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5051 unobvious parameters.
5052
5053 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5054
5055
5056stats show-node [ <name> ]
5057 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5059 yes | no | yes | yes
5060 Arguments:
5061 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5062 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5063
5064 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5065 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5066 provided for each customer.
5067
5068 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5069 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5070 unobvious parameters.
5071
5072 Example:
5073 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5074 backend private_monitoring
5075 stats enable
5076 stats show-node Europe-1
5077 stats uri /admin?stats
5078 stats refresh 5s
5079
5080 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5081 section.
5082
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005083
5084stats uri <prefix>
5085 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5087 yes | no | yes | yes
5088 Arguments :
5089 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5090 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5091 query string.
5092
5093 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5094 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5095 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5096 possible to reach it in the application.
5097
5098 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005099 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005100 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5101 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5102 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5103 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5104
5105 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5106 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5107 an address or a port to statistics only.
5108
5109 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5110 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5111 unobvious parameters.
5112
5113 Example :
5114 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5115 backend public_www
5116 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5117 stats enable
5118 stats hide-version
5119 stats scope .
5120 stats uri /admin?stats
5121 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5122 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5123 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5124
5125 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5126 backend private_monitoring
5127 stats enable
5128 stats uri /admin?stats
5129 stats refresh 5s
5130
5131 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5132
5133
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005134stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5135 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005137 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005138
5139 Arguments :
5140 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5141 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5142 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5143 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5144
5145 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5146 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5147 the "stick-table" statement.
5148
5149 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5150 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5151 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5152 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5153 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5154
5155 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5156 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5157 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5158 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5159 transformation rules.
5160
5161 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5162 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5163 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5164 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5165 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5166 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5167 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5168
5169 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5170 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5171 ACL based conditions.
5172
5173 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5174 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5175 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5176 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5177
5178 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5179 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5180 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5181 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5182
5183 Example :
5184 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5185 # last 30 minutes
5186 backend pop
5187 mode tcp
5188 balance roundrobin
5189 stick store-request src
5190 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5191 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5192 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5193
5194 backend smtp
5195 mode tcp
5196 balance roundrobin
5197 stick match src table pop
5198 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5199 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5200
5201 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5202 extraction.
5203
5204
5205stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5206 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5208 no | no | yes | yes
5209
5210 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5211 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5212 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5213 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5214
5215 Examples :
5216 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005217 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005218
5219 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5220 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5221 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5222
5223
5224 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5225 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5226 backend http
5227 mode http
5228 balance roundrobin
5229 stick on src table https
5230 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5231 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5232 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5233
5234 backend https
5235 mode tcp
5236 balance roundrobin
5237 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5238 stick on src
5239 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5240 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5241
5242 See also : "stick match" and "stick store-request"
5243
5244
5245stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5246 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5248 no | no | yes | yes
5249
5250 Arguments :
5251 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5252 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5253 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5254 server is selected.
5255
5256 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5257 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5258 the "stick-table" statement.
5259
5260 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5261 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5262 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5263 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5264 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5265 address.
5266
5267 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5268 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5269 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5270 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5271 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5272 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5273 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5274 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5275 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5276 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5277
5278 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5279 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5280 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5281 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5282 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5283 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5284 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5285
5286 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5287 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5288 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5289 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5290
5291 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5292 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5293 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5294 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5295 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5296 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5297 another protocol or access method.
5298
5299 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5300 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5301 the request.
5302
5303 Example :
5304 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5305 # last 30 minutes
5306 backend pop
5307 mode tcp
5308 balance roundrobin
5309 stick store-request src
5310 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5311 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5312 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5313
5314 backend smtp
5315 mode tcp
5316 balance roundrobin
5317 stick match src table pop
5318 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5319 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5320
5321 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5322 extraction.
5323
5324
5325stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] } size <size>
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005326 [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005327 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005329 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005330
5331 Arguments :
5332 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5333 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5334 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5335 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5336
5337 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5338 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5339 instance.
5340
5341 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5342 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5343 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5344 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5345 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5346 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
5347 to 31 characters.
5348
5349 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
5350 "string" type table. See type "string" above. Be careful when
5351 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5352 increase.
5353
5354 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005355 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5356 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5357 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005358
5359 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5360 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5361 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5362 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5363 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5364 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5365 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5366 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5367 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5368 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5369 parameter (see below).
5370
5371 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5372 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5373 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5374 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5375 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5376 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5377 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5378 if not expiration delay is specified.
5379
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005380 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5381 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5382 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5383 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005384 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5385 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5386 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5387 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5388 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5389 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5390 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5391 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5392 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5393 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5394 types and their arguments.
5395
5396 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5397 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5398 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5399 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5400
5401 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5402 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5403 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5404 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5405
5406 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5407 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5408 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5409 they were received.
5410
5411 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5412 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5413 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5414 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5415 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5416
5417 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5418 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5419 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5420 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5421 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5422
5423 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5424 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5425 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5426
5427 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5428 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5429 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5430 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5431 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5432
5433 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5434 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5435 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5436 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5437 the client side.
5438
5439 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5440 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5441 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5442 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5443 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5444 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5445 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5446
5447 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5448 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5449 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5450 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5451 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5452 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5453 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5454
5455 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5456 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5457 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5458 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5459 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5460 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5461
5462 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5463 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5464 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5465 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5466
5467 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5468 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5469 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5470 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5471 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5472 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5473 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5474 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5475 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5476 recommended for better fairness.
5477
5478 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5479 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5480 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5481 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5482
5483 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5484 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5485 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5486 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5487 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5488 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5489 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5490 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5491 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5492 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005493
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005494 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5495 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005496 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5497 reference it.
5498
5499 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5500 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5501 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5502 as an exclusive stickiness.
5503
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005504 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5505 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5506 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5507 something that can be ignored.
5508
5509 Example:
5510 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5511 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5512 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5513 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5514
5515 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
5516 about time format and section 7 avoud ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005517
5518
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005519tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5520 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5522 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005523 Arguments :
5524 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5525 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5526 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005527
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005528 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005529
5530 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5531 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005532 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5533 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5534 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5535 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5536 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5537 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005538
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005539 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5540 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5541 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5542 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005543
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005544 Three types of actions are supported :
5545 - accept :
5546 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5547 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5548 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005549
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005550 - reject :
5551 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5552 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5553 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5554 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5555 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5556 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5557 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5558 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5559 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5560 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5561 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5562 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005563
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005564 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5565 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5566 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5567 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5568 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5569 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5570 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5571 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5572 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005573
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005574 These actions take one or two arguments :
5575 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5576 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5577 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005578
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005579 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5580 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5581 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5582 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005583
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005584 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5585 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5586 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5587 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5588 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5589 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5590 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5591 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5592 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5593 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005594
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005595 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5596 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5597 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005598
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005599 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5600 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5601 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005602
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005603 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005604 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005605 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005606
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005607 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5608 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5609 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005610
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005611 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5612 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5613 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005614
5615 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5616
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005617 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005618
5619
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005620tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5621 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005623 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005624 Arguments :
5625 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5626 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5627 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005628
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005629 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005630
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005631 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5632 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5633 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5634 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5635 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005636
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005637 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5638 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5639 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5640 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5641 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5642 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5643 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5644 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5645 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005646
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005647 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5648 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5649 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5650 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005651
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005652 Three types of actions are supported :
5653 - accept :
5654 - reject :
5655 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005656
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005657 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5658 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005659
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005660 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5661 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5662 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5663 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5664 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5665 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005667 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005668 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5669 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005670
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005671 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5672 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5673 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
5674 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
5675 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005676
5677 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005678 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
5679 # and reject everything else.
5680 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
5681 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5682 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
5683 tcp-request content reject
5684
5685 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005686 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
5687 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5688 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005689 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005690
5691 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
5692 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5693 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005694 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005695 tcp-request content reject
5696
5697 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
5698 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
5699
5700 frontend http
5701 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
5702 # protecting all our sites
5703 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
5704 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5705 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
5706 ...
5707 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
5708
5709 backend http_dynamic
5710 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
5711 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
5712 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
5713 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
5714 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
5715 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
5716 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005718 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005719
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005720 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005721
5722
5723tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
5724 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
5725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005726 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005727 Arguments :
5728 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5729 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5730 as explained at the top of this document.
5731
5732 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
5733 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
5734 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
5735 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
5736 data for at most the specified amount of time.
5737
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005738 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
5739 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
5740 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
5741 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
5742
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005743 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
5744 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005745 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005746 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01005747 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
5748 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
5749 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
5750 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005751
5752 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
5753 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
5754 it pass through unaffected.
5755
5756 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
5757 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
5758 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005759 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005760 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
5761 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02005762 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
5763 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
5764 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005765
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005766 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005767 "timeout client".
5768
5769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005770timeout check <timeout>
5771 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
5772 established.
5773
5774 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5775 yes | no | yes | yes
5776 Arguments:
5777 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5778 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5779 as explained at the top of this document.
5780
5781 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
5782 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
5783 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
5784 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01005785 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
5786 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
5787 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005788
5789 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
5790 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
5791
5792 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
5793 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005794 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005795
5796 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5797 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5798 forget about it.
5799
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005800 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
5801 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005802
5803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005804timeout client <timeout>
5805timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5806 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
5807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5808 yes | yes | yes | no
5809 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005810 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005811 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5812 as explained at the top of this document.
5813
5814 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
5815 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5816 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
5817 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
5818 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
5819 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
5820 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
5821 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005822 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005823 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
5824 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
5825
5826 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
5827 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5828 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5829 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5830 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5831 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5832
5833 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
5834 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
5835 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5836
5837 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
5838
5839
5840timeout connect <timeout>
5841timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5842 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
5843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5844 yes | no | yes | yes
5845 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005846 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005847 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5848 as explained at the top of this document.
5849
5850 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005851 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005852 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005853 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005854 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
5855 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005856
5857 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5858 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5859 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5860 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5861 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
5862 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5863
5864 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
5865 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
5866 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5867
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005868 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
5869 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005870
5871
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005872timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
5873 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
5874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5875 yes | yes | yes | yes
5876 Arguments :
5877 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5878 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5879 as explained at the top of this document.
5880
5881 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
5882 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
5883 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
5884 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
5885 once the request has started to present itself.
5886
5887 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
5888 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
5889 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
5890 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
5891 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
5892
5893 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
5894 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
5895 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
5896 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
5897
5898 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
5899 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
5900 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
5901 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
5902 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02005903 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005904
5905 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
5906 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
5907 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
5908 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
5909
5910 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
5911
5912
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005913timeout http-request <timeout>
5914 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
5915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02005916 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005917 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005918 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005919 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5920 as explained at the top of this document.
5921
5922 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
5923 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
5924 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
5925 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
5926 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
5927 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
5928 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
5929 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
5930
5931 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
5932 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005933 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
5934 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005935
5936 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
5937 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
5938 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
5939 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
5940 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
5941
5942 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02005943 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
5944 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
5945 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005946
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005947 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005948
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005949
5950timeout queue <timeout>
5951 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
5952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5953 yes | no | yes | yes
5954 Arguments :
5955 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5956 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5957 as explained at the top of this document.
5958
5959 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
5960 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
5961 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
5962 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
5963 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
5964
5965 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
5966 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
5967 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
5968 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
5969
5970 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
5971
5972
5973timeout server <timeout>
5974timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5975 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5977 yes | no | yes | yes
5978 Arguments :
5979 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5980 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5981 as explained at the top of this document.
5982
5983 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5984 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5985 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5986 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5987 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5988 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5989 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5990
5991 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5992 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5993 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5994 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5995 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005996 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005997 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005998 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005999
6000 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6001 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6002 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6003 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6004 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6005 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6006
6007 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6008 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6009 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6010
6011 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6012
6013
6014timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006015 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6017 yes | yes | yes | yes
6018 Arguments :
6019 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6020 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6021 as explained at the top of this document.
6022
6023 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6024 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6025 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6026
6027 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6028 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6029 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6030 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006031 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006032
6033 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6034
6035
6036transparent (deprecated)
6037 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006039 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006040 Arguments : none
6041
6042 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6043 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6044 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6045 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6046 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6047 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6048 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6049 appropriate server.
6050
6051 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6052
6053 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6054 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6055
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006056 See also: "option transparent"
6057
6058
6059use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6060use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006061 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6063 no | yes | yes | no
6064 Arguments :
6065 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006067 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006068
6069 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6070 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6071 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006072 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6073 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6074 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6075 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006076
6077 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6078 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6079 assign the backend.
6080
6081 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6082 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6083 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6084 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6085 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6086 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6087
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006088 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006089 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006090 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6091 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6092 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6093
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006094 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006095
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006096
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010060975. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006098------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006100The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6101which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6102arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6103settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6104after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6105Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6106address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006108 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006109 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006111The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006113addr <ipv4>
6114 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6115 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6116 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6117 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6118 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006120 Supported in default-server: No
6121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006122backup
6123 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6124 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6125 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6126 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6127 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6128 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006129
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006130 Supported in default-server: No
6131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006132check
6133 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6134 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6135 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6136 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6137 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6138 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6139 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6140 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6141 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006142 "mysql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and
6143 parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006144
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006145 Supported in default-server: No
6146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006147cookie <value>
6148 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6149 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6150 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6151 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6152 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6153 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6154 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006156 Supported in default-server: No
6157
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006158disabled
6159 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6160 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6161 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6162 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6163 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6164
6165 Supported in default-server: No
6166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006167error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006168 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6169 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6170 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006172 Supported in default-server: Yes
6173
6174 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006175
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006176fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006177 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6178 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6179 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006181 Supported in default-server: Yes
6182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006183id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006184 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6185 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6186 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006187
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006188 Supported in default-server: No
6189
6190inter <delay>
6191fastinter <delay>
6192downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006193 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6194 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6195 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6196 between checks depending on the server state :
6197
6198 Server state | Interval used
6199 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6200 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6201 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6202 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6203 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6204 or yet unchecked. |
6205 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6206 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6207 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006209 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6210 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6211 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6212 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6213 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6214 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6215 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6216 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6217 servers.
6218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006219 Supported in default-server: Yes
6220
6221maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006222 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6223 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6224 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6225 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6226 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6227 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6228 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6229 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006231 Supported in default-server: Yes
6232
6233maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006234 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6235 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6236 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6237 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6238 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6239 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6240 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006242 Supported in default-server: Yes
6243
6244minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006245 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6246 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6247 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6248 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6249 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6250 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006251 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006252 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006253
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006254 Supported in default-server: Yes
6255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006256observe <mode>
6257 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6258 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6259 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6260 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6261 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6262 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6263 headers, a timeout, etc.
6264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006265 Supported in default-server: No
6266
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006267 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006269on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006270 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6271 Currently, four modes are available:
6272 - fastinter: force fastinter
6273 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6274 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6275 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6276 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6277
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006278 Supported in default-server: Yes
6279
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006280 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006282port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006283 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6284 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6285 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6286 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6287 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6288 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006290 Supported in default-server: Yes
6291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006292redir <prefix>
6293 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6294 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6295 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6296 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6297 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6298 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6299 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6300 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006301 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006302 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6303 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6304 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6305 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6306 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6307
6308 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006310 Supported in default-server: No
6311
6312rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006313 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6314 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6315 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006317 Supported in default-server: Yes
6318
6319slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006320 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6321 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6322 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6323 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6324 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6325 parameters :
6326
6327 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6328 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6329
6330 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6331 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6332 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6333 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6334
6335 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6336 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6337 seen as failed.
6338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006339 Supported in default-server: Yes
6340
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006341source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006342source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006343source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006344 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6345 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6346 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6347 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6348
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006349 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6350 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6351 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6352 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6353 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6354 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6355 server.
6356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006357 Supported in default-server: No
6358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006359track [<proxy>/]<server>
6360 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6361 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6362 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6363 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6364 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006366 Supported in default-server: No
6367
6368weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006369 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6370 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6371 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006372 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6373 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6374 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6375 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6376 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6377 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006378
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006379 Supported in default-server: Yes
6380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006381
63826. HTTP header manipulation
6383---------------------------
6384
6385In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6386response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6387request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6388which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6389against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6390to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6391passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6392headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6393never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6394
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006395There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6396(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6397rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6398messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6399in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006400happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006401add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6402normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006404This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6405in section 4.2 :
6406
6407 - reqadd <string>
6408 - reqallow <search>
6409 - reqiallow <search>
6410 - reqdel <search>
6411 - reqidel <search>
6412 - reqdeny <search>
6413 - reqideny <search>
6414 - reqpass <search>
6415 - reqipass <search>
6416 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6417 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6418 - reqtarpit <search>
6419 - reqitarpit <search>
6420 - rspadd <string>
6421 - rspdel <search>
6422 - rspidel <search>
6423 - rspdeny <search>
6424 - rspideny <search>
6425 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6426 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6427
6428With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6429is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6430parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6431prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6432Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6433
6434 \t for a tab
6435 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6436 \n for a new line (LF)
6437 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6438 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6439 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6440 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6441 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6442
6443The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6444portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6445above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6446regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
64479 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6448is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6449
6450The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6451after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6452
6453Notes related to these keywords :
6454---------------------------------
6455 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6456 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6457 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6458
6459 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6460 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6461 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6462
6463 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6464 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6465 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6466 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6467 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6468
6469 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6470 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6471 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6472 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6473 useless headers before adding new ones.
6474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006475 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006476 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6477
6478 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6479 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6480 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6481
6482 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6483 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006484 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006485
6486
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010064877. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6488------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006489
6490The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6491content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6492from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6493simple :
6494
6495 - define test criteria with sets of values
6496 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6497
6498The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6499
6500In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6501
6502 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6503
6504This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6505Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6506and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6507an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6508of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6509
6510ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6511'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6512which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6513
6514There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6515performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6516
6517The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6518
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006519 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6520 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006521 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6522
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006523The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6524specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6525possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006526multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6527be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6528needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6529space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6530match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6531lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6532duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6533to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6534instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006535
6536 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6537
6538In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6539the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6540case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6541too.
6542
6543Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6544a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6545ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006547Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006548
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006549 - integers or integer ranges
6550 - strings
6551 - regular expressions
6552 - IP addresses and networks
6553
6554
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065557.1. Matching integers
6556----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006557
6558Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6559that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6560expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6561may be omitted.
6562
6563For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6564unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6565representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6566
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006567As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6568two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6569instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6570ranges and operators.
6571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006572For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006573operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6574Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6575of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006577Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006578
6579 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6580 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6581 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6582 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6583 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6584
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006585For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006586
6587 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
6588
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006589This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
6590
6591 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
6592
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065947.2. Matching strings
6595---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006596
6597String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
6598exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
6599characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
6600string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
6601to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006602before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006603
6604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066057.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
6606-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006607
6608Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
6609they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
6610possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
6611passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
6612the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006613the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
6614match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006615
6616
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066177.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
6618----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006619
6620IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
6621netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
6622within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006623host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006624difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
6625at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
6626does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
6627parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006628
6629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066307.5. Available matching criteria
6631--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066337.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
6634------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006635
6636A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
6637analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
6638addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
6639
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006640always_false
6641 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6642 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6643
6644always_true
6645 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6646 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6647
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006648avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006649avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006650 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
6651 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
6652 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
6653 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
6654 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
6655 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
6656 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
6657 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
6658 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
6659 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
6660 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01006661
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006662be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006663be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006664 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
6665 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
6666 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6667 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
6668 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006669
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006670be_sess_rate <integer>
6671be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
6672 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
6673 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
6674 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
6675 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
6676 sucking of an online dictionary).
6677
6678 Example :
6679 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
6680 backend dynamic
6681 mode http
6682 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
6683 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006684
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006685connslots <integer>
6686connslots(backend) <integer>
6687 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006688 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006689 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
6690
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006691 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
6692 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006693
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006694 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006695 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
6696 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
6697 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
6698 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
6699 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006700 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006701
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006702 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
6703 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
6704 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
6705 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006706
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006707dst <ip_address>
6708 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
6709 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006710
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006711dst_conn <integer>
6712 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
6713 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
6714 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
6715 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
6716 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
6717 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
6718
6719dst_port <integer>
6720 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
6721 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
6722
6723fe_conn <integer>
6724fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
6725 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
6726 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
6727 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6728 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
6729 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
6730 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
6731 criteria.
6732
6733fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006734 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006735 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006736
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006737fe_sess_rate <integer>
6738fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
6739 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
6740 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
6741 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
6742 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
6743 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
6744 the rate to go down below the limit.
6745
6746 Example :
6747 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
6748 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
6749 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
6750 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
6751 frontend mail
6752 bind :25
6753 mode tcp
6754 maxconn 100
6755 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
6756 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
6757 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
6758 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006759
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006760nbsrv <integer>
6761nbsrv(backend) <integer>
6762 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
6763 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
6764 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
6765 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
6766 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006767
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006768queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02006769queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006770 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
6771 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
6772 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
6773 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
6774 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
6775 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
6776 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
6777
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006778sc1_bytes_in_rate
6779sc2_bytes_in_rate
6780 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
6781 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
6782 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
6783
6784sc1_bytes_out_rate
6785sc2_bytes_out_rate
6786 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
6787 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
6788 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
6789
6790sc1_conn_cnt
6791sc2_conn_cnt
6792 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
6793 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
6794
6795sc1_conn_cur
6796sc2_conn_cur
6797 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
6798 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
6799 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
6800
6801sc1_conn_rate
6802sc2_conn_rate
6803 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
6804 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
6805 See also src_conn_rate.
6806
6807sc1_get_gpc0
6808sc2_get_gpc0
6809 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
6810 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
6811
6812sc1_http_err_cnt
6813sc2_http_err_cnt
6814 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
6815 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
6816 See also src_http_err_cnt.
6817
6818sc1_http_err_rate
6819sc2_http_err_rate
6820 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
6821 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
6822 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
6823 src_http_err_rate.
6824
6825sc1_http_req_cnt
6826sc2_http_req_cnt
6827 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
6828 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
6829 src_http_req_cnt.
6830
6831sc1_http_req_rate
6832sc2_http_req_rate
6833 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
6834 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
6835 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
6836 src_http_req_rate.
6837
6838sc1_inc_gpc0
6839sc2_inc_gpc0
6840 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
6841 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
6842 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
6843 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
6844 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
6845 when a first ACL was verified :
6846
6847 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6848 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
6849 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
6850
6851sc1_kbytes_in
6852sc2_kbytes_in
6853 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
6854 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
6855 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
6856 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
6857
6858sc1_kbytes_out
6859sc2_kbytes_out
6860 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
6861 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
6862 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
6863 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
6864
6865sc1_sess_cnt
6866sc2_sess_cnt
6867 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
6868 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
6869 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
6870 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
6871 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
6872 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
6873
6874sc1_sess_rate
6875sc2_sess_rate
6876 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
6877 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
6878 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
6879 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
6880 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
6881 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
6882
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006883so_id <integer>
6884 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
6885
6886src <ip_address>
6887 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
6888 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
6889 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
6890
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006891src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
6892src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
6893 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
6894 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6895 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006896 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006897
6898src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
6899src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
6900 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
6901 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6902 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006903 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006904
6905src_conn_cnt <integer>
6906src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
6907 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
6908 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
6909 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006910 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006911
6912src_conn_cur <integer>
6913src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
6914 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
6915 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
6916 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006917 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006918
6919src_conn_rate <integer>
6920src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
6921 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
6922 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6923 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006924 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006925
6926src_get_gpc0 <integer>
6927src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
6928 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
6929 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
6930 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006931 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006932
6933src_http_err_cnt <integer>
6934src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
6935 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
6936 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6937 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006938 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006939
6940src_http_err_rate <integer>
6941src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
6942 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
6943 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
6944 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
6945 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006946 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006947
6948src_http_req_cnt <integer>
6949src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
6950 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
6951 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6952 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006953 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006954
6955src_http_req_rate <integer>
6956src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
6957 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
6958 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6959 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
6960 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006961 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006962
6963src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
6964src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
6965 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
6966 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6967 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
6968 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
6969 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
6970 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
6971
6972 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
6973 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006974 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006975
6976src_kbytes_in <integer>
6977src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
6978 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
6979 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6980 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
6981 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006982 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006983
6984src_kbytes_out <integer>
6985src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
6986 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
6987 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6988 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
6989 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006990 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006991
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006992src_port <integer>
6993 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006994
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006995src_sess_cnt <integer>
6996src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
6997 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
6998 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
6999 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7000 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007001 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007002
7003src_sess_rate <integer>
7004src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
7005 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7006 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7007 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7008 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007009 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007010
7011src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
7012src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007013 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007014 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7015 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007016 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7017 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7018 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007019 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007020
7021 Example :
7022 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7023 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7024 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7025 listen ssh
7026 bind :22
7027 mode tcp
7028 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007029 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007030 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7031 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7032
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007033srv_is_up(<server>)
7034srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7035 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7036 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7037 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7038 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7039 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7040 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7041 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7042 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7043
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020070457.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7046---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007047
7048A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7049during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007050through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7051keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007052
7053req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007054 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007055 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7056 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7057 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7058 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7059 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7060 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7061
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007062req_proto_http
7063 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7064 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007065 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007066 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7067 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7068
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007069req_rdp_cookie <string>
7070req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
7071 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7072 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7073 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7074 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7075 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7076 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7077 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7078 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7079
7080req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
7081req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
7082 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7083 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7084 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7085 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7086 cookies.
7087
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007088req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7089 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7090 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7091 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7092 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7093 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7094 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7095 with TCP request content inspection.
7096
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007097wait_end
7098 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7099 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7100 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7101 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7102 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7103 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7104 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7105 inspection.
7106
7107 Examples :
7108 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7109 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7110 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7111
7112 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7113 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7114 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7115 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7116 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7117 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7118 tcp-request content reject
7119
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071217.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7122--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007123
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007124A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007125application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7126read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7127than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7128
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007129hdr <string>
7130hdr(header) <string>
7131 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7132 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7133 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7134 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7135 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7136
7137 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7138 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7139 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7140
7141 hdr(Connection) -i close
7142
7143hdr_beg <string>
7144hdr_beg(header) <string>
7145 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7146 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7147 response headers sent by the server.
7148
7149hdr_cnt <integer>
7150hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7151 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7152 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7153 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7154 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7155 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7156 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7157 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7158
7159hdr_dir <string>
7160hdr_dir(header) <string>
7161 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7162 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7163 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7164 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7165 headers sent by the server.
7166
7167hdr_dom <string>
7168hdr_dom(header) <string>
7169 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7170 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7171 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7172 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7173 server.
7174
7175hdr_end <string>
7176hdr_end(header) <string>
7177 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7178 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7179 response headers sent by the server.
7180
7181hdr_ip <ip_address>
7182hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7183 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7184 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7185 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7186 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7187
7188hdr_reg <regex>
7189hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7190 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7191 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7192 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7193 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7194 response headers sent by the server.
7195
7196hdr_sub <string>
7197hdr_sub(header) <string>
7198 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7199 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7200 response headers sent by the server.
7201
7202hdr_val <integer>
7203hdr_val(header) <integer>
7204 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7205 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7206 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7207 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7208
7209http_auth(userlist)
7210http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7211 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7212 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7213 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7214 of specified groups.
7215
7216 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7217
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007218http_req_first
7219 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7220 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7221 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7222 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7223
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007224method <string>
7225 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7226 already check for most common methods.
7227
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007228path <string>
7229 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7230 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7231 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7232
7233path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007234 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7235 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007236
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007237path_dir <string>
7238 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7239 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7240 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7241 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7242
7243path_dom <string>
7244 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7245 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7246 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7247
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007248path_end <string>
7249 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7250 control file name extension.
7251
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007252path_reg <regex>
7253 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7254 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7255 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7256
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007257path_sub <string>
7258 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7259 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7260 "path_dir".
7261
7262req_ver <string>
7263 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7264 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7265
7266status <integer>
7267 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7268 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7269 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7270
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007271url <string>
7272 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7273 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7274
7275url_beg <string>
7276 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7277 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7278
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007279url_dir <string>
7280 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7281 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7282 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7283 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7284
7285url_dom <string>
7286 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7287 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7288 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7289
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007290url_end <string>
7291 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7292 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007293
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007294url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007295 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7296 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007297 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007298
7299url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007300 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7301 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007302 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007303 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007304
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007305url_reg <regex>
7306 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7307 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7308 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007309
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007310url_sub <string>
7311 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7312 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007313
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073157.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7316---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007318Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7319every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007320order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007322ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7323---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007324FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007325HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007326HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7327HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007328HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7329HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7330HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7331HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7332LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007333METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7334METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7335METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7336METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7337METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7338METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007339RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007340REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007341TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007342WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7343---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007344
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073467.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7347----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007349Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7350combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007352 - AND (implicit)
7353 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7354 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007355
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007356A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007358 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007360Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7361indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007363For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7364"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7365requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7366is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007368 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7369 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7370 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7371 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007373To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7374and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007376 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7377 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7378 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7379 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007381 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7382 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7383 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7384 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007385
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007386It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7387expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7388be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7389the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7390
7391 The following rule :
7392
7393 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7394 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7395
7396 Can also be written that way :
7397
7398 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7399
7400It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7401to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7402simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7403sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7404good use is the following :
7405
7406 With named ACLs :
7407
7408 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7409 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7410 monitor fail if site_dead
7411
7412 With anonymous ACLs :
7413
7414 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007416See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007417
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007418
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010074197.8. Pattern extraction
7420-----------------------
7421
7422The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7423response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7424for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7425
7426All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7427"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7428begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7429arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7430much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7431equivalent used in ACLs.
7432
7433The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7434
7435 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
7436 It is of type IP and only works with such tables.
7437
7438 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7439 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7440 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
7441 typie IP and only works with such tables.
7442
7443 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7444 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7445 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7446 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7447 type integer and only works with such tables.
7448
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007449 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7450 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7451 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7452 x-forwarded-for header.
7453
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007454
7455The currently available list of transformations include :
7456
7457 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7458 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7459 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7460
7461 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7462 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7463 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7464
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007465 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7466 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7467 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7468 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7469 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7470
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074728. Logging
7473----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007474
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007475One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7476provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7477very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7478provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7479state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007480to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007481headers.
7482
7483In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7484about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7485send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7486
7487 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7488 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7489 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7490 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7491 at the termination.
7492
7493The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7494allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7495as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7496while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7497real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7498delay.
7499
7500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075018.1. Log levels
7502---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007503
7504TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with informations such as date, time,
7505source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
7506HTTP request, the HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, the conditions
7507in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values, to track a
7508particular user's problems for example. All messages are sent to up to two
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007509syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more info about log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007510facilities.
7511
7512
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075138.2. Log formats
7514----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007515
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007516HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007517and will be detailed in the next sections. A few of them may slightly vary with
7518the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain options. The supported
7519formats are the following ones :
7520
7521 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7522 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7523 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
7524 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
7525 extents.
7526
7527 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
7528 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
7529 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
7530 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
7531 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
7532
7533 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
7534 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
7535 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
7536 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
7537 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
7538
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007539 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
7540 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
7541 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
7542 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
7543
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007544Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
7545specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
7546field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
7547servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
7548always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
7549identifier.
7550
7551Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
7552 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
7553 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
7554 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
7555 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
7556
7557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075588.2.1. Default log format
7559-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007560
7561This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
7562as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
7563format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
7564
7565 Example :
7566 listen www
7567 mode http
7568 log global
7569 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7570
7571 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
7572 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
7573 (www/HTTP)
7574
7575 Field Format Extract from the example above
7576 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
7577 2 'Connect from' Connect from
7578 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
7579 4 'to' to
7580 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
7581 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
7582
7583Detailed fields description :
7584 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
7585 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7586 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
7587 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
7588 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7589 and processed the connection.
7590 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
7591
7592It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
7593will eventually disappear.
7594
7595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075968.2.2. TCP log format
7597---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007598
7599The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
7600is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
7601information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
7602counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
7603emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
7604environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
7605the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
7606sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007607specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
7608not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
7609fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
7610marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007611
7612 Example :
7613 frontend fnt
7614 mode tcp
7615 option tcplog
7616 log global
7617 default_backend bck
7618
7619 backend bck
7620 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7621
7622 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
7623 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
7624 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
7625
7626 Field Format Extract from the example above
7627 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
7628 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
7629 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
7630 4 frontend_name fnt
7631 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
7632 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
7633 7 bytes_read* 212
7634 8 termination_state --
7635 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
7636 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7637
7638Detailed fields description :
7639 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
7640 connection to haproxy.
7641
7642 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7643
7644 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
7645 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
7646 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
7647 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
7648
7649 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7650 and processed the connection.
7651
7652 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7653 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7654 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
7655 applications.
7656
7657 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
7658 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
7659 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
7660 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
7661 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
7662
7663 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
7664 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
7665 See "Timers" below for more details.
7666
7667 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
7668 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
7669 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
7670 "Timers" below for more details.
7671
7672 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
7673 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
7674 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
7675 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
7676 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
7677 details.
7678
7679 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
7680 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
7681 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
7682 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
7683 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
7684
7685 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
7686 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
7687 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
7688 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
7689 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
7690 for more details.
7691
7692 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
7693 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
7694 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
7695 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
7696 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007697 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007698
7699 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
7700 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
7701 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
7702 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
7703 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
7704 caused by a denial of service attack.
7705
7706 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
7707 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
7708 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
7709 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
7710 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
7711 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
7712 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
7713 denial of service attack.
7714
7715 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
7716 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
7717 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
7718 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
7719 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
7720 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
7721 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
7722 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
7723 be processed than on other servers.
7724
7725 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
7726 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
7727 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
7728 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
7729 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
7730 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
7731 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
7732 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
7733 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
7734 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
7735 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
7736 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
7737 should not be attributed to the logged server.
7738
7739 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7740 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
7741 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
7742 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
7743 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
7744 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
7745 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
7746 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
7747
7748 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7749 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
7750 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
7751 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
7752 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
7753 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
7754 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
7755 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
7756 occurs.
7757
7758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077598.2.3. HTTP log format
7760----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007761
7762The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
7763is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
7764the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
7765are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
7766emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
7767generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
7768"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
7769which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007770frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
7771is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007772
7773Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
7774slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
7775with a star ('*') after the field name below.
7776
7777 Example :
7778 frontend http-in
7779 mode http
7780 option httplog
7781 log global
7782 default_backend bck
7783
7784 backend static
7785 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7786
7787 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7788 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7789 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007790 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007791
7792 Field Format Extract from the example above
7793 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
7794 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
7795 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
7796 4 frontend_name http-in
7797 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
7798 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
7799 7 status_code 200
7800 8 bytes_read* 2750
7801 9 captured_request_cookie -
7802 10 captured_response_cookie -
7803 11 termination_state ----
7804 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
7805 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7806 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
7807 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
7808 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007809
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007810
7811Detailed fields description :
7812 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
7813 connection to haproxy.
7814
7815 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7816
7817 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
7818 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
7819 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
7820 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
7821 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
7822
7823 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7824 and processed the connection.
7825
7826 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7827 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7828 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
7829
7830 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
7831 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
7832 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
7833 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
7834 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
7835 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
7836
7837 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
7838 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
7839 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
7840 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
7841 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
7842 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
7843
7844 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
7845 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
7846 See "Timers" below for more details.
7847
7848 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
7849 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
7850 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
7851 below for more details.
7852
7853 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
7854 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
7855 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
7856 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
7857 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
7858 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
7859 for more details.
7860
7861 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
7862 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
7863 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
7864 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
7865 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
7866 details.
7867
7868 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
7869 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
7870 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
7871
7872 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
7873 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
7874 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
7875 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
7876 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
7877 overflowing.
7878
7879 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
7880 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
7881 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
7882 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
7883 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
7884 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
7885 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
7886 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
7887
7888 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
7889 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
7890 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
7891 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
7892 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
7893 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
7894 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
7895 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
7896
7897 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
7898 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
7899 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
7900 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
7901 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
7902 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
7903 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
7904
7905 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
7906 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
7907 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
7908 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
7909 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007910 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007911 system.
7912
7913 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
7914 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
7915 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
7916 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
7917 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
7918 caused by a denial of service attack.
7919
7920 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
7921 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
7922 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
7923 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
7924 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
7925 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
7926 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
7927 denial of service attack.
7928
7929 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
7930 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
7931 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
7932 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
7933 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
7934 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
7935 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
7936 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
7937 processed than on other servers.
7938
7939 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
7940 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
7941 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
7942 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
7943 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
7944 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
7945 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
7946 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
7947 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
7948 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
7949 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
7950 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
7951 should not be attributed to the logged server.
7952
7953 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7954 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
7955 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
7956 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
7957 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
7958 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
7959 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
7960 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
7961
7962 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7963 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
7964 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
7965 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
7966 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
7967 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
7968 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
7969 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
7970 occurs.
7971
7972 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
7973 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
7974 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
7975 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
7976 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
7977 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
7978 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
7979 cookies" below for more details.
7980
7981 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
7982 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
7983 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
7984 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
7985 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
7986 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
7987 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
7988 and cookies" below for more details.
7989
7990 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
7991 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
7992 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
7993 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
7994 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
7995 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
7996 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
7997 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
7998
7999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080008.3. Advanced logging options
8001-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008002
8003Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8004just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8005options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8006for more information about their usage.
8007
8008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080098.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8010------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008011
8012It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8013haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8014commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8015monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8016ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8017
8018 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8019 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8020 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8021 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8022
8023 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8024 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8025 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8026 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8027 such as other load-balancers.
8028
8029 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8030 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8031 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8032
8033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080348.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8035----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008036
8037The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8038what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8039or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8040"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8041just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8042log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8043after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8044is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8045with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8046with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8047
8048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080498.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8050------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008051
8052Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8053for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8054"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8055retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8056raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8057a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8058file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8059you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8060"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8061
8062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080638.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8064--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008065
8066Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8067multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8068them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8069"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8070logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8071error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8072and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8073too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8074useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8075alternative.
8076
8077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080788.4. Timing events
8079------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008080
8081Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8082reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8083the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8084frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8085mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8086
8087 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8088 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8089 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8090 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8091 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8092
8093 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8094 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8095 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8096 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8097 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8098
8099 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8100 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8101 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8102 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8103 connection never established.
8104
8105 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8106 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8107 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8108 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8109 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8110 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8111 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8112 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8113 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8114 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8115 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8116
8117 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8118 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8119 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8120 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8121 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8122
8123 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8124
8125 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8126 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8127 negative.
8128
8129These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8130protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8131that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008132due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008133close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8134session has been aborted on timeout.
8135
8136Most common cases :
8137
8138 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8139 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8140 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8141 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8142 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8143 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8144 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8145 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8146 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008147 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8148 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8149 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008150
8151 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8152 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8153 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8154 of ms on remote networks.
8155
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008156 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8157 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8158 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008159
8160 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8161 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8162 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8163 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8164 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8165 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8166 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8167 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8168 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8169 to the server until another one is released.
8170
8171Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8172
8173 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8174 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8175 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8176
8177 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8178 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8179 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8180
8181 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8182 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8183 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8184 flags.
8185
8186 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8187 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8188 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8189 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8190 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8191 the client connection was maintained open.
8192
8193 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8194 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8195 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8196 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8197
8198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081998.5. Session state at disconnection
8200-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008201
8202TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8203"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
82042-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8205each of which has a special meaning :
8206
8207 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8208 session to terminate :
8209
8210 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8211
8212 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8213 server explicitly refused it.
8214
8215 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8216 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8217 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8218 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8219 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8220 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8221
8222 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8223 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8224 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8225 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8226 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8227
8228 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8229 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8230 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8231 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8232 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8233
8234 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8235 send or receive data.
8236
8237 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8238 send or receive data.
8239
8240 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8241 with nothing left in the buffers.
8242
8243 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8244
8245 R : th proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
8246 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8247
8248 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8249 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8250 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8251 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8252 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8253
8254 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8255 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8256
8257 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8258 server (HTTP only).
8259
8260 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8261
8262 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8263 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8264 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8265
8266 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8267 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8268 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8269
8270 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8271
8272 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8273 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8274
8275 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8276 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8277 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8278
8279 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8280 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008281 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8282 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008283
8284 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8285 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8286 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8287 another server.
8288
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008289 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008290 server.
8291
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008292 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8293 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8294 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8295 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8296
8297 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8298 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8299 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8300 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8301
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008302 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8303
8304 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8305 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8306
8307 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8308
8309 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8310 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8311 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8312
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008313 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8314 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8315 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8316 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8317 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8318
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008319 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8320
8321 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8322 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8323
8324 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8325
8326 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8327
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008328The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8329was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008330helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8331starvation, attacks, etc...
8332
8333The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8334alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8335easier finding and understanding.
8336
8337 Flags Reason
8338
8339 -- Normal termination.
8340
8341 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8342 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8343 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8344 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8345
8346 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8347 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8348 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8349 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8350 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8351 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008352
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008353 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8354 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8355 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8356
8357 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8358 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8359 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8360
8361 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8362 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8363 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8364 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8365 the server takes too long to respond.
8366
8367 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8368 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8369 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8370 long a time to respond.
8371
8372 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8373 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8374 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8375 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8376 and the client.
8377
8378 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8379 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8380 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8381 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8382 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8383 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8384
8385 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8386 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008387 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8388 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8389 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8390 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008391
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008392 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008393 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8394 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8395 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8396 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8397 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8398
8399 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8400 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8401 503 or 504 here.
8402
8403 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8404 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8405 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8406 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8407 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8408
8409 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8410 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008411 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008412 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8413 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8414
8415 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8416 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8417 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8418 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8419 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8420 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8421 between haproxy and the server.
8422
8423 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8424 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8425 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8426 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8427 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8428 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8429 solution is to fix the application.
8430
8431 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8432 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8433 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8434 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8435 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8436 external attacks.
8437
8438 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8439 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8440 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8441 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8442 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8443
8444 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8445 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8446 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8447 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
8448 containing unauthorized characters.
8449
8450 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8451 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8452 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8453 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8454
8455 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8456 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8457 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8458 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8459
8460 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8461 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8462 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8463 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8464
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008465The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
8466persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
8467important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
8468re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
8469
8470 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
8471
8472 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8473 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
8474 set on a GET request.
8475
8476 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
8477 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
8478 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
8479 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
8480
8481 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
8482 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
8483 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
8484
8485 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8486 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
8487 already got a cookie.
8488
8489 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8490 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
8491 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
8492 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
8493 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
8494
8495 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8496 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8497 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8498
8499 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
8500 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8501 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8502
8503 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
8504 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
8505
8506 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
8507 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
8508 then advertised in the response.
8509
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085118.6. Non-printable characters
8512-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008513
8514In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
8515consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
8516converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
8517prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
8518being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
8519escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
8520is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
8521'}' when logging headers.
8522
8523Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
8524issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
8525containing spaces is "User-Agent".
8526
8527Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
8528the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
8529performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
8530
8531
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085328.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
8533---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008534
8535Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
8536achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008537section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008538cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
8539the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
8540the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008541locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008542not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
8543user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
8544a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
8545wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
8546
8547 Examples :
8548 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
8549 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
8550
8551 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
8552 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
8553
8554
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085558.8. Capturing HTTP headers
8556---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008557
8558Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
8559proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
8560the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
8561server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
8562
8563Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
8564response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008565section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008566
8567It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008568time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
8569appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008570are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
8571and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
8572follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
8573request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
8574in the logs.
8575
8576 Example :
8577 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
8578 listen proxy-out
8579 mode http
8580 option httplog
8581 option logasap
8582 log global
8583 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
8584
8585 # log the name of the virtual server
8586 capture request header Host len 20
8587
8588 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
8589 capture request header Content-Length len 10
8590
8591 # log the beginning of the referrer
8592 capture request header Referer len 20
8593
8594 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
8595 capture response header Server len 20
8596
8597 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
8598 capture response header Content-Length len 10
8599
8600 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
8601 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
8602
8603 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
8604 capture response header Via len 20
8605
8606 # log the URL location during a redirection
8607 capture response header Location len 20
8608
8609 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
8610 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
8611 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8612 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
8613 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
8614
8615 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8616 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8617 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8618 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008619 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008620
8621 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8622 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8623 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8624 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
8625 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008626 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008627
8628
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086298.9. Examples of logs
8630---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008631
8632These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
8633them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
8634reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
8635
8636 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
8637 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8638 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8639
8640 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
8641 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
8642
8643 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
8644 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
8645 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8646
8647 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
8648 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
8649
8650 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
8651 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8652 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8653
8654 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008655 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008656 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
8657 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
8658
8659 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
8660 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
8661 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
8662
8663 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
8664 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
8665 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
8666 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
8667 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
8668 to return the 502 and not the server.
8669
8670 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008671 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008672
8673 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
8674 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
8675 Nothing was sent to any server.
8676
8677 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
8678 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
8679
8680 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
8681 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
8682 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
8683 send a 408 return code to the client.
8684
8685 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
8686 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
8687
8688 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
8689 5 seconds ("c----").
8690
8691 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
8692 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008693 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008694
8695 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008696 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008697 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
8698 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
8699 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
8700 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
8701 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008702
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087049. Statistics and monitoring
8705----------------------------
8706
8707It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
8708mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
8709CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
8710Unix socket.
8711
8712
87139.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008714---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008715
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01008716The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
8717page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
8718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008719 0. pxname: proxy name
8720 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
8721 for server)
8722 2. qcur: current queued requests
8723 3. qmax: max queued requests
8724 4. scur: current sessions
8725 5. smax: max sessions
8726 6. slim: sessions limit
8727 7. stot: total sessions
8728 8. bin: bytes in
8729 9. bout: bytes out
8730 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008731 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008732 12. ereq: request errors
8733 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01008734 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008735 15. wretr: retries (warning)
8736 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01008737 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008738 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
8739 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
8740 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
8741 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
8742 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
8743 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
8744 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
8745 25. qlimit: queue limit
8746 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
8747 27. iid: unique proxy id
8748 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
8749 29. throttle: warm up status
8750 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
8751 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008752 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02008753 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
8754 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
8755 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02008756 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008757 UNK -> unknown
8758 INI -> initializing
8759 SOCKERR -> socket error
8760 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
8761 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
8762 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
8763 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
8764 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
8765 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
8766 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
8767 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
8768 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
8769 disable-on-404
8770 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
8771 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
8772 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02008773 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
8774 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008775 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
8776 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
8777 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
8778 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
8779 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
8780 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008781 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
8782 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
8783 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
8784 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01008785 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
8786 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008787
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087899.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008790-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008791
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008792The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008793must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
8794is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
8795a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
8796risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
8797followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
8798given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
8799then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
8800to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008801
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008802It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
8803on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
8804own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008805
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008806clear counters
8807 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
8808 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
8809 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
8810 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
8811 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
8812
8813clear counters all
8814 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
8815 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
8816 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
8817
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008818clear table <table> key <key>
8819 Remove entry <key> from the stick-table <table>. The key must be of the same
8820 type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4. This is typically used
8821 un unblock some users complaining they have been abusively denied access to a
8822 service, but this can also be used to clear some stickiness entries matching
8823 a server that is going to be replaced (see "show table" below for details).
8824 Note that sometimes, removal of a key will be refused because it is currently
8825 tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds later after the session ends is
8826 usuall enough.
8827
8828 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008829 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8830 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
8831 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
8832 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
8833 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8834 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008835
8836 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8837
8838 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008839 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:1
8840 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8841 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008842
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008843disable server <backend>/<server>
8844 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
8845 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
8846 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
8847 during the maintenance.
8848
8849 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
8850 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
8851
8852 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
8853 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8854
8855 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
8856 level "admin".
8857
8858enable server <backend>/<server>
8859 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
8860 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
8861
8862 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
8863 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8864
8865 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
8866 level "admin".
8867
8868get weight <backend>/<server>
8869 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
8870 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
8871 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
8872 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
8873 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
8874 dash ('#').
8875
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008876help
8877 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
8878 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008879
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008880prompt
8881 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
8882 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
8883 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
8884 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
8885 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
8886 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
8887 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
8888 command.
8889
8890quit
8891 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008892
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008893set timeout cli <delay>
8894 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
8895 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
8896 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
8897
8898set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
8899 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
8900 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
8901 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
8902 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
8903 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
8904 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
8905 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
8906 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
8907 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
8908 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
8909 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
8910 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
8911 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
8912 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8913
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008914show errors [<iid>]
8915 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
8916 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02008917 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
8918 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
8919 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008920
8921 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
8922 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
8923 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
8924 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
8925 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
8926 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
8927 are reported too.
8928
8929 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
8930 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
8931 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
8932 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
8933 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
8934 code.
8935
8936 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
8937 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
8938 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
8939 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
8940 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
8941 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
8942 line.
8943
8944 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008945 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8946 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008947 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
8948 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
8949
8950 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
8951 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
8952 00038 Location: blah\r\n
8953 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
8954 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
8955 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
8956 00204+ minal\r\n
8957 00211 \r\n
8958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008959 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008960 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
8961 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
8962 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
8963 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
8964 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
8965 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008966
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008967show info
8968 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
8969
8970show sess
8971 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02008972 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
8973 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
8974
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01008975show sess <id>
8976 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
8977 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
8978 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
8979 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
8980 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
8981 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008982
8983show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
8984 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
8985 possible to dump only selected items :
8986 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
8987 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
8988 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
8989 for example:
8990 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
8991 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
8992 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
8993
8994 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008995 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
8996 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008997 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
8998 Release_date: 2009/09/23
8999 Nbproc: 1
9000 Process_num: 1
9001 (...)
9002
9003 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9004 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9005 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9006 (...)
9007 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9008
9009 $
9010
9011 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9012 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9013 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9014 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009015 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009016
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009017show table
9018 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9019 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9020 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9021 entries currently in use.
9022
9023 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009024 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9025 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
9026 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009027
9028show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ]
9029 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9030 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9031 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
9032 a filter in order to specify what entries to display. The filter then applies
9033 to the stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2). One stored data type
9034 has to be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table
9035 otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator>
9036 with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9037 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9038 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9039 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9040 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9041 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9042 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9043
9044 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009045 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9046 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9047 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9048 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9049 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9050 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009051
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009052 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9053 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9054 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9055 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009056
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009057 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9058 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9059 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9060 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9061 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009062
9063 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9064 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9065 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9066 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9067 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9068
9069 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9070 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9071 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009072 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9073 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009074 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9075 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009077/*
9078 * Local variables:
9079 * fill-column: 79
9080 * End:
9081 */